stmt.c (emit_case_bit_tests): New routine to implement suitable switch statements...
[gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
2 @c 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
4 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
5
6 @node Target Macros
7 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
8 @cindex machine description macros
9 @cindex target description macros
10 @cindex macros, target description
11 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
12
13 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
14 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
15 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
16 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
17 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
18 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
19 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
20 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
21 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
22 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
23 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
24 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
25 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
26
27 @menu
28 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
29 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
30 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
31 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
32 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
33 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
34 * Escape Sequences:: Defining the value of target character escape sequences
35 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
38 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
39 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
40 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
41 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
42 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
43 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
44 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
45 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
46 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
47 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
48 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
49 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
50 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
51 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
52 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
53 * Misc:: Everything else.
54 @end menu
55
56 @node Target Structure
57 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
58 @cindex target hooks
59 @cindex target functions
60
61 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
62 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
63 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
64 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
65 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
66 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
67 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
68 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
69 @smallexample
70 #include "target.h"
71 #include "target-def.h"
72
73 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
74
75 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
76 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
77
78 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
79 @end smallexample
80 @end deftypevar
81
82 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
83 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
84 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
85 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
86 @code{targetm} structure.
87
88 @node Driver
89 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
90 @cindex driver
91 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
92
93 @c prevent bad page break with this line
94 You can control the compilation driver.
95
96 @table @code
97 @findex SWITCH_TAKES_ARG
98 @item SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{char})
99 A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
100 takes arguments. The value should be the number of arguments that
101 option takes--zero, for many options.
102
103 By default, this macro is defined as
104 @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
105 properly. You need not define @code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
106 wish to add additional options which take arguments. Any redefinition
107 should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
108 additional options.
109
110 @findex WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG
111 @item WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{name})
112 A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{name}}
113 takes arguments. The value should be the number of arguments that
114 option takes--zero, for many options. This macro rather than
115 @code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} is used for multi-character option names.
116
117 By default, this macro is defined as
118 @code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
119 properly. You need not define @code{WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
120 wish to add additional options which take arguments. Any redefinition
121 should call @code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
122 additional options.
123
124 @findex SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION
125 @item SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION (@var{char})
126 A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
127 stops compilation before the generation of an executable. The value is
128 boolean, nonzero if the option does stop an executable from being
129 generated, zero otherwise.
130
131 By default, this macro is defined as
132 @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION}, which handles the standard
133 options properly. You need not define
134 @code{SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} unless you wish to add additional
135 options which affect the generation of an executable. Any redefinition
136 should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} and then check
137 for additional options.
138
139 @findex SWITCHES_NEED_SPACES
140 @item SWITCHES_NEED_SPACES
141 A string-valued C expression which enumerates the options for which
142 the linker needs a space between the option and its argument.
143
144 If this macro is not defined, the default value is @code{""}.
145
146 @findex TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE
147 @item TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE
148 If defined, a list of pairs of strings, the first of which is a
149 potential command line target to the @file{gcc} driver program, and the
150 second of which is a space-separated (tabs and other whitespace are not
151 supported) list of options with which to replace the first option. The
152 target defining this list is responsible for assuring that the results
153 are valid. Replacement options may not be the @code{--opt} style, they
154 must be the @code{-opt} style. It is the intention of this macro to
155 provide a mechanism for substitution that affects the multilibs chosen,
156 such as one option that enables many options, some of which select
157 multilibs. Example nonsensical definition, where @code{-malt-abi},
158 @code{-EB}, and @code{-mspoo} cause different multilibs to be chosen:
159
160 @smallexample
161 #define TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE \
162 @{ "-fast", "-march=fast-foo -malt-abi -I/usr/fast-foo" @}, \
163 @{ "-compat", "-EB -malign=4 -mspoo" @}
164 @end smallexample
165
166 @findex DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
167 @item DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
168 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
169 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
170
171 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
172 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
173 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
174 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
175 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
176 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
177
178 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
179 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
180 that the other specs are easier to write.
181
182 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
183
184 @findex CPP_SPEC
185 @item CPP_SPEC
186 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
187 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
188 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
189
190 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
191
192 @findex CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
193 @item CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
194 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
195 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
196 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
197
198 @findex CC1_SPEC
199 @item CC1_SPEC
200 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
201 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
202 front ends.
203 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
204 for GCC to pass to front ends.
205
206 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
207
208 @findex CC1PLUS_SPEC
209 @item CC1PLUS_SPEC
210 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
211 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
212 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
213
214 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
215 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
216 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
217 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
218
219 @findex ASM_SPEC
220 @item ASM_SPEC
221 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
222 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
223 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
224 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
225
226 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
227
228 @findex ASM_FINAL_SPEC
229 @item ASM_FINAL_SPEC
230 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
231 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
232 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
233 an example of this.
234
235 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
236
237 @findex AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
238 @item AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
239 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
240 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
241 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
242 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
243 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
244
245 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
246 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
247 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
248 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
249
250 @findex LINK_SPEC
251 @item LINK_SPEC
252 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
253 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
254 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
255
256 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
257
258 @findex LIB_SPEC
259 @item LIB_SPEC
260 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
261 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
262 command given to the linker.
263
264 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
265 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
266
267 @findex LIBGCC_SPEC
268 @item LIBGCC_SPEC
269 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
270 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
271 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
272 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
273
274 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
275 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
276
277 @findex STARTFILE_SPEC
278 @item STARTFILE_SPEC
279 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
280 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
281 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
282
283 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
284 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
285
286 @findex ENDFILE_SPEC
287 @item ENDFILE_SPEC
288 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
289 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
290 the very end of the command given to the linker.
291
292 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
293
294 @findex THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
295 @item THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
296 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
297 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
298 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
299 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
300 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
301 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
302 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
303
304 @findex EXTRA_SPECS
305 @item EXTRA_SPECS
306 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
307 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
308 @code{CC1_SPEC}.
309
310 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
311 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
312 string constant that provides the specification.
313
314 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
315
316 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
317 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
318 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
319 these definitions.
320
321 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
322 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
323 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
324 used.
325
326 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
327
328 @example
329 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
330 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
331
332 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
333 @end example
334
335 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
336 @smallexample
337 #undef CPP_SPEC
338 #define CPP_SPEC \
339 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
340 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} %@{mcall-aix: -D_CALL_AIX @} \
341 %@{!mcall-sysv: %@{!mcall-aix: %(cpp_sysv_default) @}@} \
342 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
343
344 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
345 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
346 @end smallexample
347
348 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
349 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
350
351 @smallexample
352 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
353 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
354 @end smallexample
355
356 @findex LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL
357 @item LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL
358 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
359 @file{libgcc.a} itself and should not pass @option{-L} options to the
360 linker. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
361 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search and will
362 pass @option{-L} options to it.
363
364 @findex LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
365 @item LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
366 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
367 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
368 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
369 This macro is similar to @code{LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL}, except that it does
370 not affect @option{-L} options.
371
372 @findex LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
373 @item LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
374 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
375 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
376
377 @findex LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
378 @item LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
379 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
380 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
381 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
382 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
383 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
384 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
385 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
386
387 @findex LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
388 @item LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
389 A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
390 directories from linking commands. Do not give it a nonzero value if
391 removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
392
393 @findex MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
394 @item MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
395 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
396 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
397 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
398 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
399
400 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
401 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
402 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
403 @xref{Target Fragment}.
404
405 @findex RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
406 @item RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
407 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
408 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
409 indicates an absolute file name.
410
411 @findex STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX
412 @item STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX
413 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
414 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/lib/gcc-lib/} as the default prefix to
415 try when searching for the executable files of the compiler.
416
417 @findex MD_EXEC_PREFIX
418 @item MD_EXEC_PREFIX
419 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
420 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
421 when the @option{-b} option is used, or the compiler is built as a cross
422 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
423 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
424
425 @findex STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
426 @item STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
427 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
428 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/lib/} as the default prefix to
429 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
430
431 @findex MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
432 @item MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
433 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
434 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
435 @option{-b} option is used, or when the compiler is built as a cross
436 compiler.
437
438 @findex MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
439 @item MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
440 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
441 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the @option{-b} option is
442 used, or when the compiler is built as a cross compiler.
443
444 @findex INIT_ENVIRONMENT
445 @item INIT_ENVIRONMENT
446 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
447 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
448 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
449 initialize the necessary environment variables.
450
451 @findex LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
452 @item LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
453 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
454 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
455 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
456 comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
457
458 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
459 replacement.
460
461 @findex MODIFY_TARGET_NAME
462 @item MODIFY_TARGET_NAME
463 Define this macro if you with to define command-line switches that modify the
464 default target name
465
466 For each switch, you can include a string to be appended to the first
467 part of the configuration name or a string to be deleted from the
468 configuration name, if present. The definition should be an initializer
469 for an array of structures. Each array element should have three
470 elements: the switch name (a string constant, including the initial
471 dash), one of the enumeration codes @code{ADD} or @code{DELETE} to
472 indicate whether the string should be inserted or deleted, and the string
473 to be inserted or deleted (a string constant).
474
475 For example, on a machine where @samp{64} at the end of the
476 configuration name denotes a 64-bit target and you want the @option{-32}
477 and @option{-64} switches to select between 32- and 64-bit targets, you would
478 code
479
480 @smallexample
481 #define MODIFY_TARGET_NAME \
482 @{ @{ "-32", DELETE, "64"@}, \
483 @{"-64", ADD, "64"@}@}
484 @end smallexample
485
486
487 @findex SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
488 @item SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
489 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
490 system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
491 directory. @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
492 @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
493
494 Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
495 specified.
496
497 @findex STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
498 @item STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
499 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
500 standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
501 try when searching for header files.
502
503 Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search either
504 @file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
505
506 @findex STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
507 @item STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
508 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
509 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
510 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
511
512 @findex INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
513 @item INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
514 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
515 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
516 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
517 @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
518 @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
519 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
520 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
521 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
522
523 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
524 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
525 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
526 for C++-only directories,
527 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
528 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
529 the array with a null element.
530
531 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
532 if any, in all upper-case letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
533 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
534 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
535
536 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
537
538 @example
539 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
540 @{ \
541 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
542 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
543 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
544 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
545 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
546 @}
547 @end example
548 @end table
549
550 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
551
552 @enumerate
553 @item
554 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
555
556 @item
557 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
558
559 @item
560 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
561
562 @item
563 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.
564
565 @item
566 @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}.
567
568 @item
569 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
570 @end enumerate
571
572 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
573
574 @enumerate
575 @item
576 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
577
578 @item
579 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
580
581 @item
582 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
583 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
584
585 @item
586 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.
587
588 @item
589 @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}.
590
591 @item
592 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
593
594 @item
595 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if any.
596
597 @item
598 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}.
599
600 @item
601 @file{/lib/}.
602
603 @item
604 @file{/usr/lib/}.
605 @end enumerate
606
607 @node Run-time Target
608 @section Run-time Target Specification
609 @cindex run-time target specification
610 @cindex predefined macros
611 @cindex target specifications
612
613 @c prevent bad page break with this line
614 Here are run-time target specifications.
615
616 @table @code
617 @findex TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS
618 @item TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS()
619 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
620 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target cpu, using
621 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
622 @code{builtin_assert} defined in @file{c-common.c}. When the front end
623 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
624 finished command line option processing your code can use those
625 results freely.
626
627 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
628 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
629 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
630 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
631
632 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
633 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
634 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
635 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
636 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
637 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
638 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
639 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
640 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
641 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
642
643 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
644 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
645 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
646 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
647 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
648 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
649 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
650 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
651 preprocessing.
652
653 With @code{TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS} this macro obsoletes the
654 @code{CPP_PREDEFINES} target macro.
655
656 @findex TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS
657 @item TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS()
658 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
659 and is used for the target operating system instead.
660
661 With @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} this macro obsoletes the
662 @code{CPP_PREDEFINES} target macro.
663
664 @findex CPP_PREDEFINES
665 @item CPP_PREDEFINES
666 Define this to be a string constant containing @option{-D} options to
667 define the predefined macros that identify this machine and system.
668 These macros will be predefined unless the @option{-ansi} option (or a
669 @option{-std} option for strict ISO C conformance) is specified.
670
671 In addition, a parallel set of macros are predefined, whose names are
672 made by appending @samp{__} at the beginning and at the end. These
673 @samp{__} macros are permitted by the ISO standard, so they are
674 predefined regardless of whether @option{-ansi} or a @option{-std} option
675 is specified.
676
677 For example, on the Sun, one can use the following value:
678
679 @smallexample
680 "-Dmc68000 -Dsun -Dunix"
681 @end smallexample
682
683 The result is to define the macros @code{__mc68000__}, @code{__sun__}
684 and @code{__unix__} unconditionally, and the macros @code{mc68000},
685 @code{sun} and @code{unix} provided @option{-ansi} is not specified.
686
687 @findex extern int target_flags
688 @item extern int target_flags;
689 This declaration should be present.
690
691 @cindex optional hardware or system features
692 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
693 @item TARGET_@dots{}
694 This series of macros is to allow compiler command arguments to
695 enable or disable the use of optional features of the target machine.
696 For example, one machine description serves both the 68000 and
697 the 68020; a command argument tells the compiler whether it should
698 use 68020-only instructions or not. This command argument works
699 by means of a macro @code{TARGET_68020} that tests a bit in
700 @code{target_flags}.
701
702 Define a macro @code{TARGET_@var{featurename}} for each such option.
703 Its definition should test a bit in @code{target_flags}. It is
704 recommended that a helper macro @code{TARGET_MASK_@var{featurename}}
705 is defined for each bit-value to test, and used in
706 @code{TARGET_@var{featurename}} and @code{TARGET_SWITCHES}. For
707 example:
708
709 @smallexample
710 #define TARGET_MASK_68020 1
711 #define TARGET_68020 (target_flags & TARGET_MASK_68020)
712 @end smallexample
713
714 One place where these macros are used is in the condition-expressions
715 of instruction patterns. Note how @code{TARGET_68020} appears
716 frequently in the 68000 machine description file, @file{m68k.md}.
717 Another place they are used is in the definitions of the other
718 macros in the @file{@var{machine}.h} file.
719
720 @findex TARGET_SWITCHES
721 @item TARGET_SWITCHES
722 This macro defines names of command options to set and clear
723 bits in @code{target_flags}. Its definition is an initializer
724 with a subgrouping for each command option.
725
726 Each subgrouping contains a string constant, that defines the option
727 name, a number, which contains the bits to set in
728 @code{target_flags}, and a second string which is the description
729 displayed by @option{--help}. If the number is negative then the bits specified
730 by the number are cleared instead of being set. If the description
731 string is present but empty, then no help information will be displayed
732 for that option, but it will not count as an undocumented option. The
733 actual option name is made by appending @samp{-m} to the specified name.
734 Non-empty description strings should be marked with @code{N_(@dots{})} for
735 @command{xgettext}. Please do not mark empty strings because the empty
736 string is reserved by GNU gettext. @code{gettext("")} returns the header entry
737 of the message catalog with meta information, not the empty string.
738
739 In addition to the description for @option{--help},
740 more detailed documentation for each option should be added to
741 @file{invoke.texi}.
742
743 One of the subgroupings should have a null string. The number in
744 this grouping is the default value for @code{target_flags}. Any
745 target options act starting with that value.
746
747 Here is an example which defines @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}
748 with opposite meanings, and picks the latter as the default:
749
750 @smallexample
751 #define TARGET_SWITCHES \
752 @{ @{ "68020", TARGET_MASK_68020, "" @}, \
753 @{ "68000", -TARGET_MASK_68020, \
754 N_("Compile for the 68000") @}, \
755 @{ "", TARGET_MASK_68020, "" @}@}
756 @end smallexample
757
758 @findex TARGET_OPTIONS
759 @item TARGET_OPTIONS
760 This macro is similar to @code{TARGET_SWITCHES} but defines names of command
761 options that have values. Its definition is an initializer with a
762 subgrouping for each command option.
763
764 Each subgrouping contains a string constant, that defines the fixed part
765 of the option name, the address of a variable, and a description string.
766 Non-empty description strings should be marked with @code{N_(@dots{})} for
767 @command{xgettext}. Please do not mark empty strings because the empty
768 string is reserved by GNU gettext. @code{gettext("")} returns the header entry
769 of the message catalog with meta information, not the empty string.
770
771 The variable, type @code{char *}, is set to the variable part of the
772 given option if the fixed part matches. The actual option name is made
773 by appending @samp{-m} to the specified name. Again, each option should
774 also be documented in @file{invoke.texi}.
775
776 Here is an example which defines @option{-mshort-data-@var{number}}. If the
777 given option is @option{-mshort-data-512}, the variable @code{m88k_short_data}
778 will be set to the string @code{"512"}.
779
780 @smallexample
781 extern char *m88k_short_data;
782 #define TARGET_OPTIONS \
783 @{ @{ "short-data-", &m88k_short_data, \
784 N_("Specify the size of the short data section") @} @}
785 @end smallexample
786
787 @findex TARGET_VERSION
788 @item TARGET_VERSION
789 This macro is a C statement to print on @code{stderr} a string
790 describing the particular machine description choice. Every machine
791 description should define @code{TARGET_VERSION}. For example:
792
793 @smallexample
794 #ifdef MOTOROLA
795 #define TARGET_VERSION \
796 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, Motorola syntax)");
797 #else
798 #define TARGET_VERSION \
799 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, MIT syntax)");
800 #endif
801 @end smallexample
802
803 @findex OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
804 @item OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
805 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
806 a particular target machine. You can define a macro
807 @code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS} to take account of this. This macro, if
808 defined, is executed once just after all the command options have been
809 parsed.
810
811 Don't use this macro to turn on various extra optimizations for
812 @option{-O}. That is what @code{OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS} is for.
813
814 @findex OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS
815 @item OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS (@var{level}, @var{size})
816 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
817 various optimization levels. This macro, if defined, is executed once
818 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
819 of the command options have been parsed. Values set in this macro are
820 used as the default values for the other command line options.
821
822 @var{level} is the optimization level specified; 2 if @option{-O2} is
823 specified, 1 if @option{-O} is specified, and 0 if neither is specified.
824
825 @var{size} is nonzero if @option{-Os} is specified and zero otherwise.
826
827 You should not use this macro to change options that are not
828 machine-specific. These should uniformly selected by the same
829 optimization level on all supported machines. Use this macro to enable
830 machine-specific optimizations.
831
832 @strong{Do not examine @code{write_symbols} in
833 this macro!} The debugging options are not supposed to alter the
834 generated code.
835
836 @findex CAN_DEBUG_WITHOUT_FP
837 @item CAN_DEBUG_WITHOUT_FP
838 Define this macro if debugging can be performed even without a frame
839 pointer. If this macro is defined, GCC will turn on the
840 @option{-fomit-frame-pointer} option whenever @option{-O} is specified.
841 @end table
842
843 @node Per-Function Data
844 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
845 @cindex per-function data
846 @cindex data structures
847
848 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
849 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
850 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
851 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
852 when another one comes along.
853
854 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
855 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
856 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
857 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
858 to their own specific data.
859
860 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
861 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
862 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
863 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
864
865 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
866 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
867 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
868 function, for level 0.
869
870 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
871 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
872 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
873 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
874 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
875 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
876 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
877 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
878 longer supported.
879
880 The macro and function pointers are described below.
881
882 @table @code
883 @findex INIT_EXPANDERS
884 @item INIT_EXPANDERS
885 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
886 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
887 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
888 function pointers below.
889
890 @findex init_machine_status
891 @item init_machine_status
892 This is a @code{void (*)(struct function *)} function pointer. If this
893 pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per function, before function
894 compilation starts, in order to allow the target to perform any target
895 specific initialization of the @code{struct function} structure. It is
896 intended that this would be used to initialize the @code{machine} of
897 that structure.
898
899 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC.
900 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
901 @code{ggc_alloc}, including the structure itself.
902
903 @end table
904
905 @node Storage Layout
906 @section Storage Layout
907 @cindex storage layout
908
909 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
910 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
911 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
912 @xref{Run-time Target}.
913
914 @table @code
915 @findex BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
916 @item BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
917 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
918 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
919 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
920 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
921 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
922 macro need not be a constant.
923
924 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
925 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
926
927 @findex BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
928 @item BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
929 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
930 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
931
932 @findex WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
933 @item WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
934 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
935 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
936 memory locations and registers; GCC fundamentally assumes that the
937 order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers. This
938 macro need not be a constant.
939
940 @findex LIBGCC2_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
941 @item LIBGCC2_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
942 Define this macro if @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} is not constant. This must be a
943 constant value with the same meaning as @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN}, which will be
944 used only when compiling @file{libgcc2.c}. Typically the value will be set
945 based on preprocessor defines.
946
947 @findex FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
948 @item FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
949 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
950 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
951 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
952 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
953
954 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
955 multi-word integers.
956
957 @findex BITS_PER_UNIT
958 @item BITS_PER_UNIT
959 Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
960 unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
961
962 @findex BITS_PER_WORD
963 @item BITS_PER_WORD
964 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
965 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
966
967 @findex MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
968 @item MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
969 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
970 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
971 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
972
973 @findex UNITS_PER_WORD
974 @item UNITS_PER_WORD
975 Number of storage units in a word; normally 4.
976
977 @findex MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
978 @item MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
979 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
980 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
981 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
982
983 @findex POINTER_SIZE
984 @item POINTER_SIZE
985 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
986 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
987 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
988 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
989
990 @findex POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
991 @item POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
992 A C expression whose value is greater than zero if pointers that need to be
993 extended from being @code{POINTER_SIZE} bits wide to @code{Pmode} are to
994 be zero-extended and zero if they are to be sign-extended. If the value
995 is less then zero then there must be an "ptr_extend" instruction that
996 extends a pointer from @code{POINTER_SIZE} to @code{Pmode}.
997
998 You need not define this macro if the @code{POINTER_SIZE} is equal
999 to the width of @code{Pmode}.
1000
1001 @findex PROMOTE_MODE
1002 @item PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
1003 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
1004 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
1005 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
1006 scalar type.
1007
1008 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
1009 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
1010 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
1011 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
1012 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
1013 counterparts.
1014
1015 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
1016 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
1017 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
1018 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
1019 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
1020 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
1021
1022 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
1023
1024 @findex PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS
1025 @item PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS
1026 Define this macro if the promotion described by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}
1027 should also be done for outgoing function arguments.
1028
1029 @findex PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN
1030 @item PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN
1031 Define this macro if the promotion described by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}
1032 should also be done for the return value of functions.
1033
1034 If this macro is defined, @code{FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same
1035 promotions done by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
1036
1037 @findex PROMOTE_FOR_CALL_ONLY
1038 @item PROMOTE_FOR_CALL_ONLY
1039 Define this macro if the promotion described by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}
1040 should @emph{only} be performed for outgoing function arguments or
1041 function return values, as specified by @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS}
1042 and @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN}, respectively.
1043
1044 @findex PARM_BOUNDARY
1045 @item PARM_BOUNDARY
1046 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
1047 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
1048 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
1049 size of an integer.
1050
1051 @findex STACK_BOUNDARY
1052 @item STACK_BOUNDARY
1053 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
1054 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
1055 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
1056 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
1057 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
1058
1059 @findex PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
1060 @item PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
1061 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
1062 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
1063 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
1064 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
1065 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1066
1067 @findex FORCE_PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY_IN_MAIN
1068 @item FORCE_PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY_IN_MAIN
1069 A C expression that evaluates true if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is
1070 not guaranteed by the runtime and we should emit code to align the stack
1071 at the beginning of @code{main}.
1072
1073 @cindex @code{PUSH_ROUNDING}, interaction with @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}
1074 If @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} is not defined, the stack will always be aligned
1075 to the specified boundary. If @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} is defined and specifies
1076 a less strict alignment than @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, the stack may
1077 be momentarily unaligned while pushing arguments.
1078
1079 @findex FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1080 @item FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1081 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1082
1083 @findex BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1084 @item BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1085 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in bits.
1086
1087 @findex MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1088 @item MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1089 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1090 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1091 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1092 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1093
1094 @findex BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1095 @item BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1096 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1097 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1098 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1099 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1100
1101 @findex ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN
1102 @item ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1103 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1104 alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1105 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1106 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1107 field alignment has not been set by the
1108 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1109
1110 @findex MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1111 @item MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1112 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1113 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1114 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1115 the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1116
1117 @findex DATA_ALIGNMENT
1118 @item DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1119 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1120 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1121 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1122 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1123
1124 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1125
1126 @findex strcpy
1127 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1128 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1129 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1130 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1131
1132 @findex CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT
1133 @item CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1134 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1135 that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1136 @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1137 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1138 align the object.
1139
1140 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1141
1142 The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1143 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1144 constants can be done inline.
1145
1146 @findex LOCAL_ALIGNMENT
1147 @item LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1148 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1149 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1150 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1151 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1152
1153 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1154
1155 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1156 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1157
1158 @findex EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1159 @item EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1160 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1161 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1162
1163 Note that @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} also affects the alignment
1164 that results from an empty field.
1165
1166 @findex STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1167 @item STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1168 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1169 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1170
1171 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1172 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1173
1174 @findex STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1175 @item STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1176 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1177 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1178 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1179
1180 @findex PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1181 @item PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1182 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1183 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1184
1185 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1186 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1187 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1188 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1189 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1190
1191 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1192 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1193 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1194 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1195
1196 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1197 structure.
1198
1199 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1200 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1201
1202 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1203 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1204 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1205 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1206
1207 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1208 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1209 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1210
1211 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1212 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1213 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1214
1215 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1216 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1217 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1218
1219 @example
1220 struct foo1
1221 @{
1222 char x;
1223 char :0;
1224 char y;
1225 @};
1226
1227 struct foo2
1228 @{
1229 char x;
1230 int :0;
1231 char y;
1232 @};
1233
1234 main ()
1235 @{
1236 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1237 sizeof (struct foo1));
1238 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1239 sizeof (struct foo2));
1240 exit (0);
1241 @}
1242 @end example
1243
1244 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1245 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1246
1247 @findex BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1248 @item BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1249 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1250 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1251
1252 @findex MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK
1253 @item MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
1254 Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1255 @code{BLKMODE}.
1256
1257 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1258 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1259 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1260 retain the field's mode.
1261
1262 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{c4x.h} for an example
1263 of how to use this macro to prevent a structure having a floating point
1264 field from being accessed in an integer mode.
1265
1266 @findex ROUND_TYPE_SIZE
1267 @item ROUND_TYPE_SIZE (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1268 Define this macro as an expression for the overall size of a type
1269 (given by @var{type} as a tree node) when the size computed in the
1270 usual way is @var{computed} and the alignment is @var{specified}.
1271
1272 The default is to round @var{computed} up to a multiple of @var{specified}.
1273
1274 @findex ROUND_TYPE_SIZE_UNIT
1275 @item ROUND_TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1276 Similar to @code{ROUND_TYPE_SIZE}, but sizes and alignments are
1277 specified in units (bytes). If you define @code{ROUND_TYPE_SIZE},
1278 you must also define this macro and they must be defined consistently
1279 with each other.
1280
1281 @findex ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN
1282 @item ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1283 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1284 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1285 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1286 @var{specified}.
1287
1288 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1289 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1290
1291 @findex MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1292 @item MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1293 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1294 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1295 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1296 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1297 (DImode)} is assumed.
1298
1299 @findex VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
1300 @item VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P(@var{mode})
1301 Define this macro to be nonzero if the port is prepared to handle insns
1302 involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it must have move
1303 patterns for this mode.
1304
1305 @findex STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE
1306 @item STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1307 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1308 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1309 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1310 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1311 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1312 having its mode specified.
1313
1314 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1315 would most commonly define this macro if the
1316 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1317 64-bit mode.
1318
1319 @findex STACK_SIZE_MODE
1320 @item STACK_SIZE_MODE
1321 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1322 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1323 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1324
1325 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1326 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1327 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1328
1329 @findex TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT
1330 @item TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT
1331 A code distinguishing the floating point format of the target machine.
1332 There are five defined values:
1333
1334 @table @code
1335 @findex IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
1336 @item IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
1337 This code indicates IEEE floating point. It is the default; there is no
1338 need to define this macro when the format is IEEE@.
1339
1340 @findex VAX_FLOAT_FORMAT
1341 @item VAX_FLOAT_FORMAT
1342 This code indicates the ``F float'' (for @code{float}) and ``D float''
1343 or ``G float'' formats (for @code{double}) used on the VAX and PDP-11@.
1344
1345 @findex IBM_FLOAT_FORMAT
1346 @item IBM_FLOAT_FORMAT
1347 This code indicates the format used on the IBM System/370.
1348
1349 @findex C4X_FLOAT_FORMAT
1350 @item C4X_FLOAT_FORMAT
1351 This code indicates the format used on the TMS320C3x/C4x.
1352
1353 @findex UNKNOWN_FLOAT_FORMAT
1354 @item UNKNOWN_FLOAT_FORMAT
1355 This code indicates any other format.
1356 @end table
1357
1358 If any other
1359 formats are actually in use on supported machines, new codes should be
1360 defined for them.
1361
1362 The ordering of the component words of floating point values stored in
1363 memory is controlled by @code{FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN}.
1364
1365 @findex MODE_HAS_NANS
1366 @item MODE_HAS_NANS (@var{mode})
1367 When defined, this macro should be true if @var{mode} has a NaN
1368 representation. The compiler assumes that NaNs are not equal to
1369 anything (including themselves) and that addition, subtraction,
1370 multiplication and division all return NaNs when one operand is
1371 NaN@.
1372
1373 By default, this macro is true if @var{mode} is a floating-point
1374 mode and the target floating-point format is IEEE@.
1375
1376 @findex MODE_HAS_INFINITIES
1377 @item MODE_HAS_INFINITIES (@var{mode})
1378 This macro should be true if @var{mode} can represent infinity. At
1379 present, the compiler uses this macro to decide whether @samp{x - x}
1380 is always defined. By default, the macro is true when @var{mode}
1381 is a floating-point mode and the target format is IEEE@.
1382
1383 @findex MODE_HAS_SIGNED_ZEROS
1384 @item MODE_HAS_SIGNED_ZEROS (@var{mode})
1385 True if @var{mode} distinguishes between positive and negative zero.
1386 The rules are expected to follow the IEEE standard:
1387
1388 @itemize @bullet
1389 @item
1390 @samp{x + x} has the same sign as @samp{x}.
1391
1392 @item
1393 If the sum of two values with opposite sign is zero, the result is
1394 positive for all rounding modes expect towards @minus{}infinity, for
1395 which it is negative.
1396
1397 @item
1398 The sign of a product or quotient is negative when exactly one
1399 of the operands is negative.
1400 @end itemize
1401
1402 The default definition is true if @var{mode} is a floating-point
1403 mode and the target format is IEEE@.
1404
1405 @findex MODE_HAS_SIGN_DEPENDENT_ROUNDING
1406 @item MODE_HAS_SIGN_DEPENDENT_ROUNDING (@var{mode})
1407 If defined, this macro should be true for @var{mode} if it has at
1408 least one rounding mode in which @samp{x} and @samp{-x} can be
1409 rounded to numbers of different magnitude. Two such modes are
1410 towards @minus{}infinity and towards +infinity.
1411
1412 The default definition of this macro is true if @var{mode} is
1413 a floating-point mode and the target format is IEEE@.
1414
1415 @findex ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1416 @item ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1417 If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1418 mode is towards zero. A true value has the following effects:
1419
1420 @itemize @bullet
1421 @item
1422 @code{MODE_HAS_SIGN_DEPENDENT_ROUNDING} will be false for all modes.
1423
1424 @item
1425 @file{libgcc.a}'s floating-point emulator will round towards zero
1426 rather than towards nearest.
1427
1428 @item
1429 The compiler's floating-point emulator will round towards zero after
1430 doing arithmetic, and when converting from the internal float format to
1431 the target format.
1432 @end itemize
1433
1434 The macro does not affect the parsing of string literals. When the
1435 primary rounding mode is towards zero, library functions like
1436 @code{strtod} might still round towards nearest, and the compiler's
1437 parser should behave like the target's @code{strtod} where possible.
1438
1439 Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1440
1441 @findex LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL
1442 @item LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1443 This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1444 bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1445 exponent for normal numbers instead.
1446
1447 Defining this macro to true for @var{size} causes @code{MODE_HAS_NANS}
1448 and @code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES} to be false for @var{size}-bit modes.
1449 It also affects the way @file{libgcc.a} and @file{real.c} emulate
1450 floating-point arithmetic.
1451
1452 The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1453 @end table
1454
1455 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (tree @var{record_type})
1456 This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1457 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1458 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1459 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1460 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1461 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1462 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1463 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1464 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1465 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1466 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1467
1468 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1469 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1470 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1471 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1472 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1473 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1474 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1475
1476 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1477 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1478 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1479 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1480 may affect its placement.
1481 @end deftypefn
1482
1483 @node Type Layout
1484 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1485
1486 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1487 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1488 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1489 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1490
1491 @table @code
1492 @findex INT_TYPE_SIZE
1493 @item INT_TYPE_SIZE
1494 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1495 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1496
1497 @findex SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1498 @item SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1499 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1500 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1501 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1502 unit.)
1503
1504 @findex LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1505 @item LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1506 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1507 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1508
1509 @findex ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1510 @item ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1511 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1512 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C. In
1513 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1514 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1515 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1516
1517 @findex MAX_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1518 @item MAX_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1519 Maximum number for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1520 target machine. If this is undefined, the default is
1521 @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
1522 largest value that @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time. This is
1523 used in @code{cpp}.
1524
1525 @findex LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1526 @item LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1527 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1528 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1529 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1530 macro must be at least 64.
1531
1532 @findex CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1533 @item CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1534 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1535 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1536 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1537
1538 @findex BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1539 @item BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1540 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1541 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1542 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1543
1544 @findex FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1545 @item FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1546 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1547 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1548
1549 @findex DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1550 @item DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1551 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1552 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1553 words.
1554
1555 @findex LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1556 @item LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1557 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1558 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1559 words.
1560
1561 @findex MAX_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1562 Maximum number for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on the
1563 target machine. If this is undefined, the default is
1564 @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is
1565 the largest value that @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time.
1566 This is used in @code{cpp}.
1567
1568 @findex TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1569 @item TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1570 A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1571 assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1572 default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1573 @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1574
1575 @findex WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1576 @item WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1577 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1578 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1579 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1580 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1581 is the default.
1582
1583 @findex DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1584 @item DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1585 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1586 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1587 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1588 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1589
1590 @findex DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1591 @item DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1592 A C expression to determine whether to give an @code{enum} type
1593 only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range of possible values
1594 of that type. A nonzero value means to do that; a zero value means all
1595 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1596
1597 If you don't define the macro, the default is 0.
1598
1599 @findex SIZE_TYPE
1600 @item SIZE_TYPE
1601 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1602 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1603 contents of the string.
1604
1605 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1606 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1607 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1608 of the data type names defined in the function
1609 @code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}. You may not
1610 omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1611 crash on startup.
1612
1613 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1614 int"}.
1615
1616 @findex PTRDIFF_TYPE
1617 @item PTRDIFF_TYPE
1618 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1619 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1620 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1621 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1622
1623 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1624
1625 @findex WCHAR_TYPE
1626 @item WCHAR_TYPE
1627 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1628 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1629 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1630 information.
1631
1632 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1633
1634 @findex WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1635 @item WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1636 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1637 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1638 @code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1639
1640 @findex MAX_WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1641 @item MAX_WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1642 Maximum number for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1643 characters. If this is undefined, the default is
1644 @code{WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
1645 largest value that @code{WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time. This is
1646 used in @code{cpp}.
1647
1648 @findex GCOV_TYPE_SIZE
1649 @item GCOV_TYPE_SIZE
1650 A C expression for the size in bits of the type used for gcov counters on the
1651 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one
1652 @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE} in case it is greater or equal to 64-bit and
1653 @code{LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE} otherwise. You may want to re-define the type to
1654 ensure atomicity for counters in multithreaded programs.
1655
1656 @findex WINT_TYPE
1657 @item WINT_TYPE
1658 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1659 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1660 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1661 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1662 information.
1663
1664 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1665
1666 @findex INTMAX_TYPE
1667 @item INTMAX_TYPE
1668 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1669 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1670 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1671 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1672
1673 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1674 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1675 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1676
1677 @findex UINTMAX_TYPE
1678 @item UINTMAX_TYPE
1679 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1680 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1681 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1682 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1683
1684 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1685 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1686 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1687 int}.
1688
1689 @findex TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1690 @item TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1691 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1692 that looks like:
1693
1694 @example
1695 struct @{
1696 union @{
1697 void (*fn)();
1698 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1699 @};
1700 ptrdiff_t delta;
1701 @};
1702 @end example
1703
1704 @noindent
1705 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1706 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1707 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1708 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1709 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1710 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1711 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1712 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1713
1714 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1715 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1716 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1717 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1718 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1719 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1720 architecture, you should define this macro to
1721 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1722
1723 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1724 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1725 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1726 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1727
1728 @findex TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1729 @item TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1730 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1731 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1732 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1733 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1734 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1735 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1736
1737 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1738 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1739
1740 @findex TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1741 @item TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1742 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1743 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1744 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1745 when special alignment is necessary. */
1746
1747 @findex TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1748 @item TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1749 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1750 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1751 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1752 of words in each data entry.
1753 @end table
1754
1755 @node Escape Sequences
1756 @section Target Character Escape Sequences
1757 @cindex escape sequences
1758
1759 By default, GCC assumes that the C character escape sequences take on
1760 their ASCII values for the target. If this is not correct, you must
1761 explicitly define all of the macros below.
1762
1763 @table @code
1764 @findex TARGET_BELL
1765 @item TARGET_BELL
1766 A C constant expression for the integer value for escape sequence
1767 @samp{\a}.
1768
1769 @findex TARGET_ESC
1770 @item TARGET_ESC
1771 A C constant expression for the integer value of the target escape
1772 character. As an extension, GCC evaluates the escape sequences
1773 @samp{\e} and @samp{\E} to this.
1774
1775 @findex TARGET_TAB
1776 @findex TARGET_BS
1777 @findex TARGET_NEWLINE
1778 @item TARGET_BS
1779 @itemx TARGET_TAB
1780 @itemx TARGET_NEWLINE
1781 C constant expressions for the integer values for escape sequences
1782 @samp{\b}, @samp{\t} and @samp{\n}.
1783
1784 @findex TARGET_VT
1785 @findex TARGET_FF
1786 @findex TARGET_CR
1787 @item TARGET_VT
1788 @itemx TARGET_FF
1789 @itemx TARGET_CR
1790 C constant expressions for the integer values for escape sequences
1791 @samp{\v}, @samp{\f} and @samp{\r}.
1792 @end table
1793
1794 @node Registers
1795 @section Register Usage
1796 @cindex register usage
1797
1798 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1799 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1800
1801 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1802 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1803 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1804 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1805 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1806
1807 @menu
1808 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1809 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1810 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1811 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1812 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1813 @end menu
1814
1815 @node Register Basics
1816 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1817
1818 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1819 Registers have various characteristics.
1820
1821 @table @code
1822 @findex FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1823 @item FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1824 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1825 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1826 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1827 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1828
1829 @item FIXED_REGISTERS
1830 @findex FIXED_REGISTERS
1831 @cindex fixed register
1832 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1833 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1834 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1835 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1836 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1837 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1838 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1839
1840 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1841 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1842 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1843
1844 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1845 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1846 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1847 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1848 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1849
1850 @findex CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1851 @item CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1852 @cindex call-used register
1853 @cindex call-clobbered register
1854 @cindex call-saved register
1855 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1856 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1857 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1858 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1859 function calls.
1860
1861 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1862 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1863 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1864
1865 @findex CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1866 @item CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1867 @cindex call-used register
1868 @cindex call-clobbered register
1869 @cindex call-saved register
1870 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1871 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1872 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1873 This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1874 of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1875
1876 @findex HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED
1877 @item HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1878 @cindex call-used register
1879 @cindex call-clobbered register
1880 @cindex call-saved register
1881 A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1882 value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1883 call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1884 macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1885 preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1886
1887 @findex CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1888 @findex fixed_regs
1889 @findex call_used_regs
1890 @item CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1891 Zero or more C statements that may conditionally modify five variables
1892 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1893 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1894 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1895 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1896 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1897 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1898 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1899 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1900 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1901 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1902 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1903 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1904 command options have been applied.
1905
1906 You need not define this macro if it has no work to do.
1907
1908 @cindex disabling certain registers
1909 @cindex controlling register usage
1910 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1911 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1912 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1913 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
1914 the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1915 to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1916 is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1917
1918 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1919 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1920 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1921 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1922
1923 @findex NON_SAVING_SETJMP
1924 @item NON_SAVING_SETJMP
1925 If this macro is defined and has a nonzero value, it means that
1926 @code{setjmp} and related functions fail to save the registers, or that
1927 @code{longjmp} fails to restore them. To compensate, the compiler
1928 avoids putting variables in registers in functions that use
1929 @code{setjmp}.
1930
1931 @findex INCOMING_REGNO
1932 @item INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1933 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1934 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1935 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1936 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1937 outbound register.
1938
1939 @findex OUTGOING_REGNO
1940 @item OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1941 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1942 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1943 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1944 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1945 register.
1946
1947 @findex LOCAL_REGNO
1948 @item LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1949 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1950 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1951 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1952 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1953 gotos.
1954
1955 @ignore
1956 @findex PC_REGNUM
1957 @item PC_REGNUM
1958 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1959 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1960 @end ignore
1961 @end table
1962
1963 @node Allocation Order
1964 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1965 @cindex order of register allocation
1966 @cindex register allocation order
1967
1968 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1969 Registers are allocated in order.
1970
1971 @table @code
1972 @findex REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1973 @item REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1974 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1975 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1976 to use them (from most preferred to least).
1977
1978 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1979 (all else being equal).
1980
1981 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1982 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1983 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1984 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1985 the highest numbered allocable register first.
1986
1987 @findex ORDER_REGS_FOR_LOCAL_ALLOC
1988 @item ORDER_REGS_FOR_LOCAL_ALLOC
1989 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1990 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1991
1992 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1993 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1994 register; and so on.
1995
1996 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
1997 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
1998
1999 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2000 @end table
2001
2002 @node Values in Registers
2003 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2004
2005 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2006 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2007 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2008
2009 @table @code
2010 @findex HARD_REGNO_NREGS
2011 @item HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2012 A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2013 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2014 @var{mode}.
2015
2016 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2017 definition of this macro is
2018
2019 @smallexample
2020 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2021 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2022 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2023 @end smallexample
2024
2025 @findex HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2026 @item HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2027 A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2028 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2029 registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2030 are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2031
2032 @smallexample
2033 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2034 @end smallexample
2035
2036 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2037 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2038
2039 @cindex register pairs
2040 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2041 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2042 odd register numbers for such modes.
2043
2044 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2045 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2046 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2047 value into the register and back out not alter it.
2048
2049 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2050 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2051 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2052 you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2053 is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2054 and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2055 to be tieable.
2056
2057 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2058 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2059 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2060 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2061 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2062 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2063
2064 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2065 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2066 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2067 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2068 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2069 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2070 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2071 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2072 register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2073
2074 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2075 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2076 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2077 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2078 constraints for those instructions.
2079
2080 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2081 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2082 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2083 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2084 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2085
2086 @findex MODES_TIEABLE_P
2087 @item MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2088 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2089 @var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2090
2091 If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2092 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2093 any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2094 should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2095 this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2096 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2097
2098 You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2099 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2100 allocation.
2101
2102 @findex AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2103 @item AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2104 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2105 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2106 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2107 @end table
2108
2109 @node Leaf Functions
2110 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2111
2112 @cindex leaf functions
2113 @cindex functions, leaf
2114 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2115 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2116 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2117 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2118 normally arrive.
2119
2120 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2121 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2122 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2123 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2124 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2125 functions''.
2126
2127 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2128 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2129 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2130 accomplish this.
2131
2132 @table @code
2133 @findex LEAF_REGISTERS
2134 @item LEAF_REGISTERS
2135 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2136 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2137 function treatment.
2138
2139 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2140 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2141 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2142 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2143 in this vector.
2144
2145 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2146 the treatment of leaf functions.
2147
2148 @findex LEAF_REG_REMAP
2149 @item LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2150 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2151 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2152
2153 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2154 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2155 will cause the compiler to abort.
2156
2157 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2158 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2159 this.
2160 @end table
2161
2162 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2163 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2164 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2165 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2166 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2167 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2168 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2169 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2170 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2171 functions which only use leaf registers.
2172 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after reload and is
2173 only useful if @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2174 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2175 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2176
2177 @node Stack Registers
2178 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2179
2180 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2181 ``registers'' form a stack, as in the 80387 coprocessor for the 80386.
2182 Stack registers are normally written by pushing onto the stack, and are
2183 numbered relative to the top of the stack.
2184
2185 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2186 they must be consecutively numbered.
2187
2188 @table @code
2189 @findex STACK_REGS
2190 @item STACK_REGS
2191 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2192
2193 @findex FIRST_STACK_REG
2194 @item FIRST_STACK_REG
2195 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2196 of the stack.
2197
2198 @findex LAST_STACK_REG
2199 @item LAST_STACK_REG
2200 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2201 the stack.
2202 @end table
2203
2204 @node Register Classes
2205 @section Register Classes
2206 @cindex register class definitions
2207 @cindex class definitions, register
2208
2209 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2210 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2211 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2212 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2213
2214 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2215 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2216 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2217
2218 @findex ALL_REGS
2219 @findex NO_REGS
2220 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2221 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2222 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2223 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2224
2225 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2226 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2227 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2228 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2229 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2230 to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2231
2232 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2233 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2234
2235 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2236 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2237 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2238 them in operand constraints.
2239
2240 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2241 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2242 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2243 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2244 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code.
2245
2246 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2247 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2248 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2249 in their union.
2250
2251 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2252 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2253 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2254 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2255 specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2256
2257 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2258 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2259 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2260 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2261 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2262 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2263 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2264 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2265 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2266
2267 @table @code
2268 @findex enum reg_class
2269 @item enum reg_class
2270 An enumeral type that must be defined with all the register class names
2271 as enumeral values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2272 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumeral value,
2273 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2274 tells how many classes there are.
2275
2276 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2277 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2278 in many of the tables described below.
2279
2280 @findex N_REG_CLASSES
2281 @item N_REG_CLASSES
2282 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2283
2284 @example
2285 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2286 @end example
2287
2288 @findex REG_CLASS_NAMES
2289 @item REG_CLASS_NAMES
2290 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2291 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2292
2293 @findex REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2294 @item REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2295 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2296 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2297 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2298 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2299
2300 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2301 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2302 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2303 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2304 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2305 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2306 so on.
2307
2308 @findex REGNO_REG_CLASS
2309 @item REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2310 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2311 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2312 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2313 register.
2314
2315 @findex BASE_REG_CLASS
2316 @item BASE_REG_CLASS
2317 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2318 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2319 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2320
2321 @findex MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS
2322 @item MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2323 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2324 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2325 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2326 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2327
2328 @findex INDEX_REG_CLASS
2329 @item INDEX_REG_CLASS
2330 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2331 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2332 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2333 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2334
2335 @findex CONSTRAINT_LEN
2336 @item CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2337 For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2338 @var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2339 constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2340 you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2341 constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2342 DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2343 to handle specially.
2344 There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2345 for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2346 transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2347 return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2348 will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2349
2350 @findex REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER
2351 @item REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2352 A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2353 letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2354 value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2355 the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2356 corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2357 to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2358
2359 @findex REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT
2360 @item REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2361 Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2362 passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2363 different variants.
2364
2365 @findex REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P
2366 @item REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2367 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2368 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses. It may be
2369 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2370 allocated such a hard register.
2371
2372 @findex REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P
2373 @item REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2374 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2375 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2376 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2377 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2378 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2379 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2380
2381 @findex REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P
2382 @item REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2383 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2384 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2385 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2386 allocated such a hard register.
2387
2388 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2389 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2390 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2391 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2392 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2393 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2394 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2395 only if neither labeling works.
2396
2397 @findex PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
2398 @item PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2399 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2400 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2401 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2402 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2403 safe:
2404
2405 @example
2406 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2407 @end example
2408
2409 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2410 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2411 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2412 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2413 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2414
2415 If @var{x} is a @code{const_double}, by returning @code{NO_REGS}
2416 you can force @var{x} into a memory constant. This is useful on
2417 certain machines where immediate floating values cannot be loaded into
2418 certain kinds of registers.
2419
2420 @findex PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2421 @item PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2422 Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2423 input reloads. If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
2424 @var{class}, unchanged.
2425
2426 @findex LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS
2427 @item LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2428 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2429 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2430 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2431 ordinarily be used.
2432
2433 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2434 there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2435
2436 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2437 smaller class.
2438
2439 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2440 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2441
2442 @findex SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS
2443 @findex SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2444 @findex SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2445 @item SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2446 @itemx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2447 @itemx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2448 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2449 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2450 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2451 from general registers, but not memory. Some machines allow copying all
2452 registers to and from memory, but require a scratch register for stores
2453 to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic address on the RT,
2454 and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC when compiling
2455 PIC)@. In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are
2456 required.
2457
2458 You should define these macros to indicate to the reload phase that it may
2459 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2460 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2461 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2462 you should define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2463 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2464 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2465
2466 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2467 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2468 should be defined to return the largest register class required. If the
2469 requirements for input and output reloads are the same, the macro
2470 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should be used instead of defining both
2471 macros identically.
2472
2473 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2474 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2475 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2476 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2477 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2478
2479 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2480 intermediate register), you should define patterns for
2481 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2482 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which will normally be
2483 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2484 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2485 register.
2486
2487 Define constraints for the reload register and scratch register that
2488 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2489 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2490 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2491 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2492 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2493
2494 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2495 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2496 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2497 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2498
2499 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2500 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2501 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2502 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2503 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2504 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2505 general registers.
2506
2507 @findex SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
2508 @item SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2509 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2510 to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2511 those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2512 @var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2513 class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2514 and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2515
2516 Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2517
2518 @findex SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX
2519 @item SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2520 Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2521 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2522 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2523 defined by this macro.
2524
2525 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2526 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2527
2528 @findex SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE
2529 @item SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2530 When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2531 registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2532 hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2533 load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2534 same as that of @var{mode}.
2535
2536 This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2537 bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2538 in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2539 registers.
2540
2541 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2542 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2543 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2544 widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2545 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2546 details.
2547
2548 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2549 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2550 is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2551
2552 @findex SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES
2553 @item SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES
2554 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
2555 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
2556 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
2557 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
2558 insn.
2559
2560 Define @code{SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES} to be an expression with a nonzero
2561 value on these machines. When this macro has a nonzero value, the
2562 compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of hard registers.
2563
2564 It is always safe to define this macro with a nonzero value, but if you
2565 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
2566 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this macro
2567 with a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out of
2568 spill registers and print a fatal error message. For most machines, you
2569 should not define this macro at all.
2570
2571 @findex CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
2572 @item CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (@var{class})
2573 A C expression whose value is nonzero if pseudos that have been assigned
2574 to registers of class @var{class} would likely be spilled because
2575 registers of @var{class} are needed for spill registers.
2576
2577 The default value of this macro returns 1 if @var{class} has exactly one
2578 register and zero otherwise. On most machines, this default should be
2579 used. Only define this macro to some other expression if pseudos
2580 allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their hard
2581 registers were needed for spill registers. If this macro returns nonzero
2582 for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2583 @file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2584 register. If there would not be another register available for
2585 reallocation, you should not change the definition of this macro since
2586 the only effect of such a definition would be to slow down register
2587 allocation.
2588
2589 @findex CLASS_MAX_NREGS
2590 @item CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2591 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2592 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2593
2594 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2595 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2596 should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2597 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2598
2599 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2600 in the reload pass.
2601
2602 @item CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(@var{from}, @var{to})
2603 If defined, a C expression that returns a register class for which
2604 a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid, otherwise the
2605 macro returns @code{NO_REGS}.
2606
2607 For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2608 floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2609 Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2610 does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2611 register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2612 as below:
2613
2614 @example
2615 #define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS \
2616 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) ? FLOAT_REGS : NO_REGS)
2617 @end example
2618 @end table
2619
2620 Three other special macros describe which operands fit which constraint
2621 letters.
2622
2623 @table @code
2624 @findex CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P
2625 @item CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2626 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2627 letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2628 particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2629 letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2630 the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2631 not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2632 @var{value}.
2633
2634 @findex CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P
2635 @item CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2636 Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2637 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2638 between different variants.
2639
2640 @findex CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P
2641 @item CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2642 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2643 letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2644 (@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2645
2646 If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2647 @var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2648 range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2649 letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2650
2651 @code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2652 @code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2653 or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2654 between these kinds.
2655
2656 @findex CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P
2657 @item CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2658 Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2659 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2660 between different variants.
2661
2662 @findex EXTRA_CONSTRAINT
2663 @item EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2664 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2665 letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2666 memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
2667 elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2668 @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2669 may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2670
2671 If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2672 if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2673 constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2674 constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2675
2676 For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2677 in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
2678 letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2679 @emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
2680 a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
2681 alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2682 does not include r0 on the output.
2683
2684 @findex EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR
2685 @item EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2686 Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
2687 in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
2688 variants.
2689
2690 @findex EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT
2691 @item EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2692 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2693 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
2694 be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
2695
2696 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2697 at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
2698 comprises a subset of all memory references including
2699 all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
2700 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2701 type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
2702
2703 For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
2704 memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
2705 register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
2706 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
2707 If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
2708 a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
2709 reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
2710 into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
2711 a @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
2712
2713 @findex EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT
2714 @item EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2715 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2716 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
2717 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
2718 be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
2719
2720 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2721 at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
2722 a subset of all memory addresses including
2723 all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
2724 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2725 type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
2726
2727 Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
2728 be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
2729 analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
2730 @end table
2731
2732 @node Stack and Calling
2733 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2734 @cindex calling conventions
2735
2736 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2737 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
2738
2739 @menu
2740 * Frame Layout::
2741 * Exception Handling::
2742 * Stack Checking::
2743 * Frame Registers::
2744 * Elimination::
2745 * Stack Arguments::
2746 * Register Arguments::
2747 * Scalar Return::
2748 * Aggregate Return::
2749 * Caller Saves::
2750 * Function Entry::
2751 * Profiling::
2752 * Tail Calls::
2753 @end menu
2754
2755 @node Frame Layout
2756 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
2757 @cindex stack frame layout
2758 @cindex frame layout
2759
2760 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2761 Here is the basic stack layout.
2762
2763 @table @code
2764 @findex STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2765 @item STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2766 Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
2767 pointer to a smaller address.
2768
2769 When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{},'' it means that the
2770 compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
2771 definition used does not matter.
2772
2773 @findex STACK_PUSH_CODE
2774 @item STACK_PUSH_CODE
2775
2776 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
2777 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
2778 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
2779
2780 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
2781 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
2782 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
2783 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
2784 space for the next item on the stack.
2785
2786 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
2787 defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
2788 which is often wrong.
2789
2790 @findex FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2791 @item FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2792 Define this macro if the addresses of local variable slots are at negative
2793 offsets from the frame pointer.
2794
2795 @findex ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
2796 @item ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
2797 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
2798 addresses on the stack.
2799
2800 @findex STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
2801 @item STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
2802 Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
2803
2804 If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
2805 subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2806 Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
2807 value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2808 @c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
2809 @c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
2810
2811 @findex STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
2812 @item STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
2813 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
2814 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
2815 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
2816
2817 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2818 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
2819
2820 @findex FIRST_PARM_OFFSET
2821 @item FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2822 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
2823 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
2824 function.
2825
2826 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2827 the first argument's address.
2828
2829 @findex STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET
2830 @item STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2831 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
2832 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
2833
2834 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
2835 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
2836 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
2837
2838 @findex DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS
2839 @item DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
2840 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
2841 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
2842 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
2843 itself.
2844
2845 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
2846 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
2847 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
2848
2849 @findex SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
2850 @item SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
2851 If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
2852 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
2853 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
2854 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
2855 define this macro.
2856
2857 @findex BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
2858 @item BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
2859 If defined, a C expression that contains an rtx that is used to store
2860 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
2861 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
2862 machines. One reason you may need to define this macro is if
2863 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
2864
2865 @findex RETURN_ADDR_RTX
2866 @item RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
2867 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
2868 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
2869 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
2870 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
2871 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
2872
2873 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
2874 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is not way to
2875 determine the return address of other frames.
2876
2877 @findex RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
2878 @item RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
2879 Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
2880 from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
2881
2882 @findex INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
2883 @item INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
2884 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
2885 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
2886 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
2887 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
2888 the stack.
2889
2890 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
2891 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
2892
2893 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
2894 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
2895
2896 @findex INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
2897 @item INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
2898 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
2899 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
2900 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
2901 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
2902 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
2903
2904 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
2905 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
2906
2907 @findex ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
2908 @item ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2909 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
2910 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
2911 final value should coincide with that calculated by
2912 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
2913 during virtual register instantiation.
2914
2915 The default value for this macro is @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl)},
2916 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
2917 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
2918 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
2919 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
2920
2921 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
2922 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
2923 DWARF 2.
2924
2925 @findex SMALL_STACK
2926 @item SMALL_STACK
2927 Define this macro if the stack size for the target is very small. This
2928 has the effect of disabling gcc's built-in @samp{alloca}, though
2929 @samp{__builtin_alloca} is not affected.
2930 @end table
2931
2932 @node Exception Handling
2933 @subsection Exception Handling Support
2934 @cindex exception handling
2935
2936 @table @code
2937 @findex EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO
2938 @item EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
2939 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
2940 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
2941 @var{N} registers are usable.
2942
2943 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
2944 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
2945 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
2946 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
2947 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
2948
2949 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
2950 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
2951
2952 @findex EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
2953 @item EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
2954 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
2955 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
2956 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
2957 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
2958
2959 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
2960 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
2961
2962 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
2963 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
2964
2965 @findex EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
2966 @item EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
2967 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
2968 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
2969 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
2970
2971 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
2972 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
2973 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
2974 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
2975 frame. @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already been assigned,
2976 so it may be used to calculate the location of the target call frame.
2977
2978 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
2979 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
2980 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
2981
2982 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
2983 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
2984
2985 @findex ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT
2986 @item ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT(@var{code}, @var{global})
2987 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
2988 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
2989 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
2990 and so may be read-only.
2991
2992 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
2993 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
2994 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
2995 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
2996
2997 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
2998 represented directly.
2999
3000 @findex ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX
3001 @item ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX(@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3002 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3003 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3004 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3005 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3006
3007 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3008 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3009 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3010 to be emitted.
3011
3012 @findex MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR
3013 @item MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR(@var{context}, @var{fs}, @var{success})
3014 This macro allows the target to add cpu and operating system specific
3015 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3016 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3017 through signal frames.
3018
3019 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in @file{unwind-dw2.c}
3020 and @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3021 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3022 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3023 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register save
3024 addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should branch to
3025 @var{success}. If the frame cannot be decoded, the macro should do
3026 nothing.
3027 @end table
3028
3029 @node Stack Checking
3030 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3031
3032 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of
3033 the stack, if the @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of three ways:
3034
3035 @enumerate
3036 @item
3037 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3038 will assume that you have arranged for stack checking to be done at
3039 appropriate places in the configuration files, e.g., in
3040 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}. GCC will do not other special
3041 processing.
3042
3043 @item
3044 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and you defined a named pattern
3045 called @code{check_stack} in your @file{md} file, GCC will call that
3046 pattern with one argument which is the address to compare the stack
3047 value against. You must arrange for this pattern to report an error if
3048 the stack pointer is out of range.
3049
3050 @item
3051 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3052 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3053 @end enumerate
3054
3055 Normally, you will use the default values of these macros, so GCC
3056 will use the third approach.
3057
3058 @table @code
3059 @findex STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3060 @item STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3061 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3062 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3063 is require by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to have to stack
3064 checking in some more efficient way than GCC's portable approach.
3065 The default value of this macro is zero.
3066
3067 @findex STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL
3068 @item STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL
3069 An integer representing the interval at which GCC must generate stack
3070 probe instructions. You will normally define this macro to be no larger
3071 than the size of the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The
3072 default value of 4096 is suitable for most systems.
3073
3074 @findex STACK_CHECK_PROBE_LOAD
3075 @item STACK_CHECK_PROBE_LOAD
3076 A integer which is nonzero if GCC should perform the stack probe
3077 as a load instruction and zero if GCC should use a store instruction.
3078 The default is zero, which is the most efficient choice on most systems.
3079
3080 @findex STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3081 @item STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3082 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow,
3083 for languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of
3084 75 words should be adequate for most machines.
3085
3086 @findex STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3087 @item STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3088 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3089 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3090 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3091 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3092 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3093 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3094
3095 @findex STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3096 @item STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3097 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3098 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3099 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3100 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3101 use the default of four words.
3102
3103 @findex STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3104 @item STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3105 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3106 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3107 @option{-fstack-check}.
3108 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3109 normally not need to override that default.
3110 @end table
3111
3112 @need 2000
3113 @node Frame Registers
3114 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3115
3116 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3117 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3118
3119 @table @code
3120 @findex STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3121 @item STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3122 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3123 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3124 the hardware determines which register this is.
3125
3126 @findex FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3127 @item FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3128 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3129 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3130 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3131 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3132
3133 @findex HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3134 @item HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3135 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3136 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3137 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3138 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3139 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3140 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3141 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3142 used for the frame pointer.
3143
3144 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3145 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3146 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3147 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3148 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3149 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3150 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3151
3152 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3153 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3154
3155 @findex ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3156 @item ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3157 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3158 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3159 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3160 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3161 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3162 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3163 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3164 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3165
3166 @findex RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3167 @item RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3168 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3169 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3170 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3171 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3172 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3173 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3174
3175 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3176 address from the stack.
3177
3178 @findex STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3179 @findex STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3180 @item STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3181 @itemx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3182 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3183 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3184 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3185 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3186 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3187 not be defined.
3188
3189 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3190
3191 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3192 defined; instead, the next two macros should be defined.
3193
3194 @findex STATIC_CHAIN
3195 @findex STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING
3196 @item STATIC_CHAIN
3197 @itemx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING
3198 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros provide rtx giving
3199 @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3200 @code{STATIC_CHAIN} and @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING} give the locations
3201 as seen by the calling and called functions, respectively. Often the former
3202 will be at an offset from the stack pointer and the latter at an offset from
3203 the frame pointer.
3204
3205 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
3206 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
3207 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
3208 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3209 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized prior to the use of these
3210 macros and should be used to refer to those items.
3211
3212 If the static chain is passed in a register, the two previous macros should
3213 be defined instead.
3214
3215 @findex DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3216 @item DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3217 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3218 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3219 DWARF2 exception handling.
3220
3221 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3222 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3223 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3224 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3225 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3226 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3227 registers that are not call-saved.
3228
3229 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3230 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3231
3232 @findex PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3233 @item PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3234
3235 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3236 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3237
3238 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3239 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3240
3241 @end table
3242
3243 @node Elimination
3244 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3245
3246 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3247 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3248
3249 @table @code
3250 @findex FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3251 @item FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3252 A C expression which is nonzero if a function must have and use a frame
3253 pointer. This expression is evaluated in the reload pass. If its value is
3254 nonzero the function will have a frame pointer.
3255
3256 The expression can in principle examine the current function and decide
3257 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant 0 or the
3258 constant 1 suffices. Use 0 when the machine allows code to be generated
3259 with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space. Use 1
3260 when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame pointer.
3261
3262 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3263 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3264 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3265 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} says. You don't need to worry about
3266 them.
3267
3268 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3269 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3270 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3271
3272 @findex INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET
3273 @findex get_frame_size
3274 @item INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3275 A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3276 between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3277 the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3278 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3279 registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3280
3281 If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3282 need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3283 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} is defined to always be true; in that
3284 case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3285
3286 @findex ELIMINABLE_REGS
3287 @item ELIMINABLE_REGS
3288 If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3289 eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3290 defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3291 references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3292
3293 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3294 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3295
3296 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3297 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3298 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3299 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3300 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3301
3302 In this case, you might specify:
3303 @example
3304 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3305 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3306 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3307 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3308 @end example
3309
3310 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3311 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3312
3313 @findex CAN_ELIMINATE
3314 @item CAN_ELIMINATE (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg})
3315 A C expression that returns nonzero if the compiler is allowed to try
3316 to replace register number @var{from-reg} with register number
3317 @var{to-reg}. This macro need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3318 is defined, and will usually be the constant 1, since most of the cases
3319 preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3320 knows about.
3321
3322 @findex INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET
3323 @item INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3324 This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3325 specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3326 registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3327 defined.
3328 @end table
3329
3330 @node Stack Arguments
3331 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3332 @cindex arguments on stack
3333 @cindex stack arguments
3334
3335 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3336 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3337 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3338
3339 @table @code
3340 @findex PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3341 @item PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3342 A C expression whose value is nonzero if an argument declared in
3343 a prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should
3344 actually be passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding
3345 errors in certain cases of mismatch, it also makes for better
3346 code on certain machines. If the macro is not defined in target
3347 header files, it defaults to 0.
3348
3349 @findex PUSH_ARGS
3350 @item PUSH_ARGS
3351 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3352 outgoing arguments.
3353 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3354 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3355 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3356 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3357
3358 @findex PUSH_ROUNDING
3359 @item PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3360 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3361 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3362
3363 On some machines, the definition
3364
3365 @example
3366 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3367 @end example
3368
3369 @noindent
3370 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3371 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3372 alignment. Then the definition should be
3373
3374 @example
3375 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3376 @end example
3377
3378 @findex ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3379 @findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3380 @item ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3381 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3382 will be computed and placed into the variable
3383 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3384 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3385 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3386
3387 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3388 is not proper.
3389
3390 @findex REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3391 @item REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3392 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3393 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3394 registers.
3395
3396 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3397 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3398 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3399
3400 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3401 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3402 which.
3403 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3404 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3405
3406 @findex MAYBE_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3407 @findex FINAL_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3408 @item MAYBE_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3409 @itemx FINAL_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{const_size}, @var{var_size})
3410 Define these macros in addition to the one above if functions might
3411 allocate stack space for arguments even when their values are passed
3412 in registers. These should be used when the stack space allocated
3413 for arguments in registers is not a simple constant independent of the
3414 function declaration.
3415
3416 The value of the first macro is the size, in bytes, of the area that
3417 we should initially assume would be reserved for arguments passed in registers.
3418
3419 The value of the second macro is the actual size, in bytes, of the area
3420 that will be reserved for arguments passed in registers. This takes two
3421 arguments: an integer representing the number of bytes of fixed sized
3422 arguments on the stack, and a tree representing the number of bytes of
3423 variable sized arguments on the stack.
3424
3425 When these macros are defined, @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} will only be
3426 called for libcall functions, the current function, or for a function
3427 being called when it is known that such stack space must be allocated.
3428 In each case this value can be easily computed.
3429
3430 When deciding whether a called function needs such stack space, and how
3431 much space to reserve, GCC uses these two macros instead of
3432 @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}.
3433
3434 @findex OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3435 @item OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3436 Define this if it is the responsibility of the caller to allocate the area
3437 reserved for arguments passed in registers.
3438
3439 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3440 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3441 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3442
3443 @findex STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3444 @item STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3445 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3446 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3447 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3448 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3449
3450 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3451 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3452 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3453 stack in its natural location.
3454
3455 @findex RETURN_POPS_ARGS
3456 @item RETURN_POPS_ARGS (@var{fundecl}, @var{funtype}, @var{stack-size})
3457 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes of its own
3458 arguments that a function pops on returning, or 0 if the
3459 function pops no arguments and the caller must therefore pop them all
3460 after the function returns.
3461
3462 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3463 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3464 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3465 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3466
3467 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3468 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3469 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3470 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3471 arguments (if known).
3472
3473 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3474 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3475 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3476 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3477 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3478 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3479
3480 @var{stack-size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3481 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3482 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3483
3484 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3485 of this macro is @var{stack-size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3486 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3487 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3488 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3489 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3490 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3491 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3492 number of arguments.
3493
3494 @findex CALL_POPS_ARGS
3495 @item CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3496 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3497 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3498 when compiling a function call.
3499
3500 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3501 have been accumulated.
3502
3503 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3504 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3505 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3506 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3507 appropriate.
3508
3509 @end table
3510
3511 @node Register Arguments
3512 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3513 @cindex arguments in registers
3514 @cindex registers arguments
3515
3516 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3517 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3518 the stack.
3519
3520 @table @code
3521 @findex FUNCTION_ARG
3522 @item FUNCTION_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3523 A C expression that controls whether a function argument is passed
3524 in a register, and which register.
3525
3526 The arguments are @var{cum}, which summarizes all the previous
3527 arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3528 the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3529 (which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3530 which is 1 for an ordinary argument and 0 for nameless arguments that
3531 correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called function's prototype.
3532 @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a syntax error has previously
3533 occurred.
3534
3535 The value of the expression is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the
3536 hard register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the
3537 argument on the stack.
3538
3539 For machines like the VAX and 68000, where normally all arguments are
3540 pushed, zero suffices as a definition.
3541
3542 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3543 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3544 of the @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3545 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3546 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3547 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3548 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3549 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3550 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3551 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3552 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3553 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3554 argument is also stored on the stack.
3555
3556 The last time this macro is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
3557 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3558 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3559
3560 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
3561 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a machine
3562 where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to cause
3563 nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is done
3564 by making @code{FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever @var{named} is 0.
3565
3566 @cindex @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
3567 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
3568 You may use the macro @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (@var{mode}, @var{type})}
3569 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
3570 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
3571 is not defined and @code{FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
3572 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
3573 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
3574 a register.
3575
3576 @findex MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
3577 @item MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3578 Define as a C expression that evaluates to nonzero if we do not know how
3579 to pass TYPE solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
3580 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
3581 documentation.
3582
3583 @findex FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
3584 @item FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3585 Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
3586 that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
3587 necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
3588 argument.
3589
3590 For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in which
3591 the caller passes the value, and @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should
3592 be defined in a similar fashion to tell the function being called
3593 where the arguments will arrive.
3594
3595 If @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined, @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
3596 serves both purposes.
3597
3598 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_PARTIAL_NREGS
3599 @item FUNCTION_ARG_PARTIAL_NREGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3600 A C expression for the number of words, at the beginning of an
3601 argument, that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
3602 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
3603 pushed on the stack.
3604
3605 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
3606 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
3607 first @var{n} words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
3608 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
3609 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
3610 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
3611 compiler when this occurs, and how many of the words should go in
3612 registers.
3613
3614 @code{FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
3615 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
3616 @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
3617
3618 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
3619 @item FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3620 A C expression that indicates when an argument must be passed by reference.
3621 If nonzero for an argument, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
3622 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
3623 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
3624 to that type.
3625
3626 On machines where @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is not defined, a suitable
3627 definition of this macro might be
3628 @smallexample
3629 #define FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE\
3630 (CUM, MODE, TYPE, NAMED) \
3631 MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (MODE, TYPE)
3632 @end smallexample
3633 @c this is *still* too long. --mew 5feb93
3634
3635 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES
3636 @item FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3637 If defined, a C expression that indicates when it is the called function's
3638 responsibility to make a copy of arguments passed by invisible reference.
3639 Normally, the caller makes a copy and passes the address of the copy to the
3640 routine being called. When @code{FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES} is defined and is
3641 nonzero, the caller does not make a copy. Instead, it passes a pointer to the
3642 ``live'' value. The called function must not modify this value. If it can be
3643 determined that the value won't be modified, it need not make a copy;
3644 otherwise a copy must be made.
3645
3646 @findex CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3647 @item CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3648 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument of
3649 @code{FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some target machines,
3650 the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number of bytes of
3651 argument so far.
3652
3653 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
3654 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
3655 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
3656 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
3657 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
3658 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
3659
3660 @findex INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3661 @item INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{indirect})
3662 A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable @var{cum}
3663 for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The variable has
3664 type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype} is the tree node
3665 for the data type of the function which will receive the args, or 0
3666 if the args are to a compiler support library function. The value of
3667 @var{indirect} is nonzero when processing an indirect call, for example
3668 a call through a function pointer. The value of @var{indirect} is zero
3669 for a call to an explicitly named function, a library function call, or when
3670 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
3671 being compiled.
3672
3673 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
3674 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
3675 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
3676 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
3677 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
3678 never both of them at once.
3679
3680 @findex INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS
3681 @item INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
3682 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
3683 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
3684 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
3685 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
3686 0)} is used instead.
3687
3688 @findex INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS
3689 @item INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
3690 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
3691 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
3692 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
3693
3694 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
3695 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
3696 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
3697 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
3698 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
3699 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
3700
3701 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE
3702 @item FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3703 A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the summarizer variable
3704 @var{cum} to advance past an argument in the argument list. The
3705 values @var{mode}, @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument.
3706 Once this is done, the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing
3707 the @emph{following} argument with @code{FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
3708
3709 This macro need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
3710 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
3711 used for arguments without any special help.
3712
3713 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING
3714 @item FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3715 If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
3716 to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
3717 @code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
3718 @code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
3719
3720 The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
3721 multiple of @code{FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not control
3722 it.
3723
3724 This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
3725 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
3726 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
3727 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
3728
3729 @findex PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
3730 @item PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
3731 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
3732 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
3733 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
3734 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
3735 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
3736
3737 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY
3738 @item FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3739 If defined, a C expression that gives the alignment boundary, in bits,
3740 of an argument with the specified mode and type. If it is not defined,
3741 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} is used for all arguments.
3742
3743 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P
3744 @item FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
3745 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
3746 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
3747 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
3748 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
3749 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
3750 stack.
3751
3752 @findex LOAD_ARGS_REVERSED
3753 @item LOAD_ARGS_REVERSED
3754 If defined, the order in which arguments are loaded into their
3755 respective argument registers is reversed so that the last
3756 argument is loaded first. This macro only affects arguments
3757 passed in registers.
3758
3759 @end table
3760
3761 @node Scalar Return
3762 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
3763 @cindex return values in registers
3764 @cindex values, returned by functions
3765 @cindex scalars, returned as values
3766
3767 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
3768 values---values that can fit in registers.
3769
3770 @table @code
3771 @findex FUNCTION_VALUE
3772 @item FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
3773 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a
3774 function returns a value of data type @var{valtype}. @var{valtype} is
3775 a tree node representing a data type. Write @code{TYPE_MODE
3776 (@var{valtype})} to get the machine mode used to represent that type.
3777 On many machines, only the mode is relevant. (Actually, on most
3778 machines, scalar values are returned in the same place regardless of
3779 mode).
3780
3781 The value of the expression is usually a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3782 register where the return value is stored. The value can also be a
3783 @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in multiple places. See
3784 @code{FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the @code{parallel} form.
3785
3786 If @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} is defined, you must apply the same
3787 promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if @var{valtype} is a
3788 scalar type.
3789
3790 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
3791 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
3792 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
3793 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
3794 known.
3795
3796 @code{FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return vales with aggregate data
3797 types, because these are returned in another way. See
3798 @code{STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM} and related macros, below.
3799
3800 @findex FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE
3801 @item FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
3802 Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows''
3803 so that the register in which a function returns its value is not
3804 the same as the one in which the caller sees the value.
3805
3806 For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_VALUE} computes the register in which
3807 the caller will see the value. @code{FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE} should be
3808 defined in a similar fashion to tell the function where to put the
3809 value.
3810
3811 If @code{FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE} is not defined,
3812 @code{FUNCTION_VALUE} serves both purposes.
3813
3814 @code{FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE} is not used for return vales with
3815 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
3816 @code{STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM} and related macros, below.
3817
3818 @findex LIBCALL_VALUE
3819 @item LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
3820 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
3821 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}. If the precise function
3822 being called is known, @var{func} is a tree node
3823 (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
3824 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
3825 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
3826 known.
3827
3828 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
3829 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
3830 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
3831 compiled.
3832
3833 The definition of @code{LIBRARY_VALUE} need not be concerned aggregate
3834 data types, because none of the library functions returns such types.
3835
3836 @findex FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
3837 @item FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
3838 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
3839 register in which the values of called function may come back.
3840
3841 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
3842 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
3843 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
3844 suffices:
3845
3846 @example
3847 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
3848 @end example
3849
3850 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
3851 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
3852 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
3853
3854 @findex APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
3855 @item APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
3856 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
3857 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
3858 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
3859 @end table
3860
3861 @node Aggregate Return
3862 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
3863 @cindex aggregates as return values
3864 @cindex large return values
3865 @cindex returning aggregate values
3866 @cindex structure value address
3867
3868 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
3869 cases), the value is not returned according to @code{FUNCTION_VALUE}
3870 (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the caller passes the address of a
3871 block of memory in which the value should be stored. This address
3872 is called the @dfn{structure value address}.
3873
3874 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
3875 memory.
3876
3877 @table @code
3878 @findex RETURN_IN_MEMORY
3879 @item RETURN_IN_MEMORY (@var{type})
3880 A C expression which can inhibit the returning of certain function
3881 values in registers, based on the type of value. A nonzero value says
3882 to return the function value in memory, just as large structures are
3883 always returned. Here @var{type} will be a C expression of type
3884 @code{tree}, representing the data type of the value.
3885
3886 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
3887 by this macro. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
3888 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
3889 possible to leave the macro undefined; this causes a default
3890 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
3891 values, and 0 otherwise.
3892
3893 Do not use this macro to indicate that structures and unions should always
3894 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
3895 to indicate this.
3896
3897 @findex DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
3898 @item DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
3899 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
3900 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
3901 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
3902 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
3903 and union return values are decided by the @code{RETURN_IN_MEMORY} macro.
3904
3905 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
3906
3907 @findex STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM
3908 @item STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM
3909 If the structure value address is passed in a register, then
3910 @code{STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM} should be the number of that register.
3911
3912 @findex STRUCT_VALUE
3913 @item STRUCT_VALUE
3914 If the structure value address is not passed in a register, define
3915 @code{STRUCT_VALUE} as an expression returning an RTX for the place
3916 where the address is passed. If it returns 0, the address is passed as
3917 an ``invisible'' first argument.
3918
3919 @findex STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING_REGNUM
3920 @item STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING_REGNUM
3921 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
3922 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
3923 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
3924 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
3925
3926 If the incoming location of the structure value address is in a
3927 register, define this macro as the register number.
3928
3929 @findex STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING
3930 @item STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING
3931 If the incoming location is not a register, then you should define
3932 @code{STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING} as an expression for an RTX for where the
3933 called function should find the value. If it should find the value on
3934 the stack, define this to create a @code{mem} which refers to the frame
3935 pointer. A definition of 0 means that the address is passed as an
3936 ``invisible'' first argument.
3937
3938 @findex PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
3939 @item PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
3940 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
3941 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
3942 the address of a static variable containing the value.
3943
3944 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
3945 pass an address to the subroutine.
3946
3947 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
3948 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
3949 @end table
3950
3951 @node Caller Saves
3952 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
3953
3954 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
3955 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
3956 must live across calls.
3957
3958 @table @code
3959 @findex DEFAULT_CALLER_SAVES
3960 @item DEFAULT_CALLER_SAVES
3961 Define this macro if function calls on the target machine do not preserve
3962 any registers; in other words, if @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} has 1
3963 for all registers. When defined, this macro enables @option{-fcaller-saves}
3964 by default for all optimization levels. It has no effect for optimization
3965 levels 2 and higher, where @option{-fcaller-saves} is the default.
3966
3967 @findex CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE
3968 @item CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
3969 A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
3970 a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
3971 restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
3972 this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
3973
3974 If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
3975 machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
3976
3977 @findex HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE
3978 @item HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
3979 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
3980 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
3981 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
3982 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
3983 will select the smallest suitable mode.
3984 @end table
3985
3986 @node Function Entry
3987 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
3988 @cindex function entry and exit
3989 @cindex prologue
3990 @cindex epilogue
3991
3992 This section describes the macros that output function entry
3993 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
3994
3995 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
3996 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
3997 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
3998 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
3999 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4000 local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4001 stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4002
4003 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4004 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4005
4006 @findex regs_ever_live
4007 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4008 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4009 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4010 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4011 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4012 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
4013
4014 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4015 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4016 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4017 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4018 registers are used in the function.
4019
4020 @findex frame_pointer_needed
4021 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4022 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4023 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4024 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4025 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4026 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4027
4028 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4029 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4030 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4031 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4032 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4033 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4034 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4035 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4036 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4037 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4038 @end deftypefn
4039
4040 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4041 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4042 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4043 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4044 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4045 @end deftypefn
4046
4047 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4048 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4049 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4050 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4051 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4052 @end deftypefn
4053
4054 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4055 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4056 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4057 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4058 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4059 same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4060 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4061 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4062
4063 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4064 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4065 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4066 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4067
4068 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4069 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4070 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4071 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4072 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4073 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4074
4075 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4076 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4077 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4078 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4079 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4080 a function that needs a frame pointer.
4081
4082 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4083 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4084 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4085 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4086
4087 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4088 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4089 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4090 number of arguments.
4091
4092 @findex current_function_pops_args
4093 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4094 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4095 needs to know what was decided. The variable that is called
4096 @code{current_function_pops_args} is the number of bytes of its
4097 arguments that a function should pop. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4098 @c what is the "its arguments" in the above sentence referring to, pray
4099 @c tell? --mew 5feb93
4100 @end deftypefn
4101
4102 @table @code
4103
4104 @itemize @bullet
4105 @item
4106 @findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4107 A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4108 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4109 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4110 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4111 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4112 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4113 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4114 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4115 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4116
4117 @item
4118 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4119 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4120 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4121 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4122 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4123 a save area.
4124
4125 @item
4126 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4127 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4128 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4129 save area closer to the top of the stack.
4130
4131 @item
4132 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4133 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4134 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4135 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4136 @end itemize
4137
4138 Normally, it is necessary for the macros
4139 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4140 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to treat leaf functions specially.
4141 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4142 function.
4143
4144 @findex EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4145 @item EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4146 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4147 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4148 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4149 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function.
4150
4151 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4152 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4153 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4154 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4155
4156 @findex EPILOGUE_USES
4157 @item EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4158 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4159 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4160 pointer registers are already be assumed to be used as needed.
4161
4162 @findex EH_USES
4163 @item EH_USES (@var{regno})
4164 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4165 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4166 on entry to an exception edge.
4167
4168 @findex DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4169 @item DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4170 Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4171 instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4172 definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4173 representing the number of delay slots there.
4174
4175 @findex ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY
4176 @item ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4177 A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4178 slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4179
4180 The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4181 being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4182 eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4183 of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4184 If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4185 may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4186 (at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4187 slot.
4188
4189 @findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4190 @findex final_scan_insn
4191 The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4192 list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4193 @code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
4194 delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
4195 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4196 outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4197 @code{final_scan_insn}.
4198
4199 You need not define this macro if you did not define
4200 @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4201
4202 @end table
4203
4204 @findex TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4205 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, tree @var{function})
4206 A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4207 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4208 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4209 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4210 the real function.
4211
4212 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4213 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4214 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4215 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4216 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4217 all other incoming arguments.
4218
4219 After the addition, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4220 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4221 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4222 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4223
4224 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4225 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4226 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4227 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4228
4229 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4230 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4231 some targets, but probably not.
4232
4233 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4234 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4235 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4236 not support varargs.
4237 @end deftypefn
4238
4239 @findex TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_VCALL_THUNK
4240 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_VCALL_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, int @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
4241 A function like @code{TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK}, except that if
4242 @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be made
4243 after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4244 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4245
4246 @example
4247 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4248 @end example
4249
4250 @noindent
4251 If this function is defined, it will always be used in place of
4252 @code{TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK}.
4253
4254 @end deftypefn
4255
4256 @node Profiling
4257 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4258 @cindex profiling, code generation
4259
4260 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4261
4262 @table @code
4263 @findex FUNCTION_PROFILER
4264 @item FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4265 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4266 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4267
4268 @findex mcount
4269 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4270 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4271 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4272 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4273
4274 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4275 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4276 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4277 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4278
4279 @findex PROFILE_HOOK
4280 @item PROFILE_HOOK
4281 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4282 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4283 not support profiling.
4284
4285 @findex NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4286 @item NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4287 Define this macro if the @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does
4288 not need a counter variable allocated for each function. This is true
4289 for almost all modern implementations. If you define this macro, you
4290 must not use the @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4291
4292 @findex PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4293 @item PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4294 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4295 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4296 @end table
4297
4298 @node Tail Calls
4299 @subsection Permitting tail calls
4300 @cindex tail calls
4301
4302 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
4303 True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4304 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4305 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4306
4307 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4308 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4309 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4310 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4311 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4312 may vary greatly between different architectures.
4313 @end deftypefn
4314
4315 @node Varargs
4316 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4317 @cindex varargs implementation
4318
4319 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4320 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4321 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4322 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4323 conditionals to include it.
4324
4325 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4326 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4327 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4328 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4329 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4330 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4331
4332 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4333 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4334 below.
4335
4336 @table @code
4337 @findex __builtin_saveregs
4338 @item __builtin_saveregs ()
4339 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4340 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4341 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4342 you use @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4343
4344 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4345 control of the macro @code{EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On other machines,
4346 it calls a routine written in assembler language, found in
4347 @file{libgcc2.c}.
4348
4349 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4350 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4351 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4352 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4353 to use them for its own purposes.
4354 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4355 @c 10feb93
4356
4357 @findex __builtin_args_info
4358 @item __builtin_args_info (@var{category})
4359 Use this built-in function to find the first anonymous arguments in
4360 registers.
4361
4362 In general, a machine may have several categories of registers used for
4363 arguments, each for a particular category of data types. (For example,
4364 on some machines, floating-point registers are used for floating-point
4365 arguments while other arguments are passed in the general registers.)
4366 To make non-varargs functions use the proper calling convention, you
4367 have defined the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data type to record how many
4368 registers in each category have been used so far
4369
4370 @code{__builtin_args_info} accesses the same data structure of type
4371 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} after the ordinary argument layout is finished
4372 with it, with @var{category} specifying which word to access. Thus, the
4373 value indicates the first unused register in a given category.
4374
4375 Normally, you would use @code{__builtin_args_info} in the implementation
4376 of @code{va_start}, accessing each category just once and storing the
4377 value in the @code{va_list} object. This is because @code{va_list} will
4378 have to update the values, and there is no way to alter the
4379 values accessed by @code{__builtin_args_info}.
4380
4381 @findex __builtin_next_arg
4382 @item __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
4383 This is the equivalent of @code{__builtin_args_info}, for stack
4384 arguments. It returns the address of the first anonymous stack
4385 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
4386 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4387 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4388 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4389 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4390 of the current function.
4391
4392 @findex __builtin_classify_type
4393 @item __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
4394 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4395 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4396 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
4397 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4398 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4399
4400 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4401 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
4402 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4403
4404 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4405 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
4406 @end table
4407
4408 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4409
4410 @table @code
4411 @findex EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
4412 @item EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS ()
4413 If defined, is a C expression that produces the machine-specific code
4414 for a call to @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the
4415 very beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made.
4416 The return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the
4417 value to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
4418
4419 @findex SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
4420 @item SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (@var{args_so_far}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{pretend_args_size}, @var{second_time})
4421 This macro offers an alternative to using @code{__builtin_saveregs} and
4422 defining the macro @code{EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the
4423 anonymous register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments
4424 appear to have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is
4425 done, you can use the standard implementation of varargs that works for
4426 machines that pass all their arguments on the stack.
4427
4428 The argument @var{args_so_far} is the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
4429 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
4430 named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
4431 last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
4432
4433 The macro implementation should do two things: first, push onto the
4434 stack all the argument registers @emph{not} used for the named
4435 arguments, and second, store the size of the data thus pushed into the
4436 @code{int}-valued variable whose name is supplied as the argument
4437 @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you store here will serve as
4438 additional offset for setting up the stack frame.
4439
4440 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
4441 compile time without knowing their data types,
4442 @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that have just
4443 a single category of argument register and use it uniformly for all data
4444 types.
4445
4446 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
4447 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
4448 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
4449 end of the source file. The macro @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
4450 not generate any instructions in this case.
4451
4452 @findex STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
4453 @item STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
4454 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the location where a function
4455 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
4456
4457 This macro controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4458 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this macro returns a
4459 nonzero value, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
4460 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns a value of
4461 zero, but @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is defined, then all arguments
4462 are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments except the last
4463 are treated as named.
4464
4465 You need not define this macro if it always returns zero.
4466
4467 @findex PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
4468 @item PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
4469 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
4470 @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
4471 @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
4472 defined, then define this macro to return nonzero if
4473 @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, zero otherwise.
4474 Otherwise, you should not define this macro.
4475 @end table
4476
4477 @node Trampolines
4478 @section Trampolines for Nested Functions
4479 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
4480 @cindex nested functions, trampolines for
4481
4482 A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
4483 when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
4484 the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
4485 tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
4486 trampoline.
4487
4488 The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
4489 address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
4490 the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
4491 two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
4492 exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
4493 machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
4494 two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
4495 operands.
4496
4497 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
4498 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
4499 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
4500 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
4501 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
4502 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
4503 separately.
4504
4505 @table @code
4506 @findex TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
4507 @item TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (@var{file})
4508 A C statement to output, on the stream @var{file}, assembler code for a
4509 block of data that contains the constant parts of a trampoline. This
4510 code should not include a label---the label is taken care of
4511 automatically.
4512
4513 If you do not define this macro, it means no template is needed
4514 for the target. Do not define this macro on systems where the block move
4515 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
4516 to generate it on the spot.
4517
4518 @findex TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
4519 @item TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
4520 The name of a subroutine to switch to the section in which the
4521 trampoline template is to be placed (@pxref{Sections}). The default is
4522 a value of @samp{readonly_data_section}, which places the trampoline in
4523 the section containing read-only data.
4524
4525 @findex TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
4526 @item TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
4527 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
4528
4529 @findex TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
4530 @item TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
4531 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
4532
4533 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
4534 is used for aligning trampolines.
4535
4536 @findex INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE
4537 @item INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE (@var{addr}, @var{fnaddr}, @var{static_chain})
4538 A C statement to initialize the variable parts of a trampoline.
4539 @var{addr} is an RTX for the address of the trampoline; @var{fnaddr} is
4540 an RTX for the address of the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
4541 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
4542 when it is called.
4543
4544 @findex TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
4545 @item TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (@var{addr})
4546 A C statement that should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
4547 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address that
4548 was passed to @code{INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE}. In case the address to be
4549 used for a function call should be different from the address in which
4550 the template was stored, the different address should be assigned to
4551 @var{addr}. If this macro is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for
4552 function calls.
4553
4554 @findex ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE
4555 @item ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE (@var{fp})
4556 A C expression to allocate run-time space for a trampoline. The
4557 expression value should be an RTX representing a memory reference to the
4558 space for the trampoline.
4559
4560 @cindex @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} and trampolines
4561 @cindex @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and trampolines
4562 If this macro is not defined, by default the trampoline is allocated as
4563 a stack slot. This default is right for most machines. The exceptions
4564 are machines where it is impossible to execute instructions in the stack
4565 area. On such machines, you may have to implement a separate stack,
4566 using this macro in conjunction with @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4567 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}.
4568
4569 @var{fp} points to a data structure, a @code{struct function}, which
4570 describes the compilation status of the immediate containing function of
4571 the function which the trampoline is for. Normally (when
4572 @code{ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE} is not defined), the stack slot for the
4573 trampoline is in the stack frame of this containing function. Other
4574 allocation strategies probably must do something analogous with this
4575 information.
4576 @end table
4577
4578 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
4579 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
4580 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
4581 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
4582
4583 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
4584 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
4585 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
4586 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
4587 latter makes initialization faster.
4588
4589 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
4590 the following macros which describe the shape of the cache.
4591
4592 @table @code
4593 @findex INSN_CACHE_SIZE
4594 @item INSN_CACHE_SIZE
4595 The total size in bytes of the cache.
4596
4597 @findex INSN_CACHE_LINE_WIDTH
4598 @item INSN_CACHE_LINE_WIDTH
4599 The length in bytes of each cache line. The cache is divided into cache
4600 lines which are disjoint slots, each holding a contiguous chunk of data
4601 fetched from memory. Each time data is brought into the cache, an
4602 entire line is read at once. The data loaded into a cache line is
4603 always aligned on a boundary equal to the line size.
4604
4605 @findex INSN_CACHE_DEPTH
4606 @item INSN_CACHE_DEPTH
4607 The number of alternative cache lines that can hold any particular memory
4608 location.
4609 @end table
4610
4611 Alternatively, if the machine has system calls or instructions to clear
4612 the instruction cache directly, you can define the following macro.
4613
4614 @table @code
4615 @findex CLEAR_INSN_CACHE
4616 @item CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
4617 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
4618 cache} in the specified interval. If it is not defined, and the macro
4619 @code{INSN_CACHE_SIZE} is defined, some generic code is generated to clear the
4620 cache. The definition of this macro would typically be a series of
4621 @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and @var{end} are both pointer
4622 expressions.
4623 @end table
4624
4625 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
4626 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
4627 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
4628 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
4629 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
4630
4631 @table @code
4632 @findex TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
4633 @item TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
4634 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
4635 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
4636 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
4637 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
4638
4639 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
4640 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
4641 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
4642 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
4643 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
4644 special assembler code.
4645 @end table
4646
4647 @node Library Calls
4648 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
4649 @cindex library subroutine names
4650 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
4651
4652 @c prevent bad page break with this line
4653 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
4654
4655 @table @code
4656 @findex MULSI3_LIBCALL
4657 @item MULSI3_LIBCALL
4658 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4659 multiplication of one signed full-word by another. If you do not
4660 define this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__mulsi3},
4661 a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4662
4663 @findex DIVSI3_LIBCALL
4664 @item DIVSI3_LIBCALL
4665 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4666 division of one signed full-word by another. If you do not define
4667 this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__divsi3}, a
4668 function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4669
4670 @findex UDIVSI3_LIBCALL
4671 @item UDIVSI3_LIBCALL
4672 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4673 division of one unsigned full-word by another. If you do not define
4674 this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__udivsi3}, a
4675 function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4676
4677 @findex MODSI3_LIBCALL
4678 @item MODSI3_LIBCALL
4679 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4680 remainder in division of one signed full-word by another. If you do
4681 not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4682 @code{__modsi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4683
4684 @findex UMODSI3_LIBCALL
4685 @item UMODSI3_LIBCALL
4686 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4687 remainder in division of one unsigned full-word by another. If you do
4688 not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4689 @code{__umodsi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4690
4691 @findex MULDI3_LIBCALL
4692 @item MULDI3_LIBCALL
4693 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4694 multiplication of one signed double-word by another. If you do not
4695 define this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__muldi3},
4696 a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4697
4698 @findex DIVDI3_LIBCALL
4699 @item DIVDI3_LIBCALL
4700 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4701 division of one signed double-word by another. If you do not define
4702 this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__divdi3}, a
4703 function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4704
4705 @findex UDIVDI3_LIBCALL
4706 @item UDIVDI3_LIBCALL
4707 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4708 division of one unsigned full-word by another. If you do not define
4709 this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__udivdi3}, a
4710 function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4711
4712 @findex MODDI3_LIBCALL
4713 @item MODDI3_LIBCALL
4714 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4715 remainder in division of one signed double-word by another. If you do
4716 not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4717 @code{__moddi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4718
4719 @findex UMODDI3_LIBCALL
4720 @item UMODDI3_LIBCALL
4721 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4722 remainder in division of one unsigned full-word by another. If you do
4723 not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4724 @code{__umoddi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4725
4726 @findex DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
4727 @item DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
4728 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
4729 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
4730 provide alternate names for gcc's internal library functions if there
4731 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
4732
4733 @findex INIT_TARGET_OPTABS
4734 @item INIT_TARGET_OPTABS
4735 Define this macro as a C statement that declares additional library
4736 routines renames existing ones. @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after
4737 initializing all the normal library routines.
4738
4739 @findex FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
4740 @item FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL
4741 Define this macro as a C statement that returns nonzero if a call to
4742 the floating point comparison library function will return a boolean
4743 value that indicates the result of the comparison. It should return
4744 zero if one of gcc's own libgcc functions is called.
4745
4746 Most ports don't need to define this macro.
4747
4748 @findex TARGET_EDOM
4749 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
4750 @item TARGET_EDOM
4751 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
4752 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
4753 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
4754 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
4755 system.
4756
4757 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
4758 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
4759 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
4760 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
4761 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
4762
4763 @findex GEN_ERRNO_RTX
4764 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
4765 @item GEN_ERRNO_RTX
4766 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
4767 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
4768 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
4769 macro, a reasonable default is used.
4770
4771 @findex TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
4772 @cindex @code{bcopy}, implicit usage
4773 @cindex @code{memcpy}, implicit usage
4774 @cindex @code{memmove}, implicit usage
4775 @cindex @code{bzero}, implicit usage
4776 @cindex @code{memset}, implicit usage
4777 @item TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
4778 Define this macro if GCC should generate calls to the ISO C
4779 (and System V) library functions @code{memcpy}, @code{memmove} and
4780 @code{memset} rather than the BSD functions @code{bcopy} and @code{bzero}.
4781
4782 @findex TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
4783 @cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
4784 @item TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
4785 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
4786 @code{sinf} and similary for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
4787 default is nonzero that should be proper value for most modern systems, however
4788 number of existing systems lacks support for these functions in the runtime so
4789 they needs this macro to be redefined to 0.
4790
4791 @findex LIBGCC_NEEDS_DOUBLE
4792 @item LIBGCC_NEEDS_DOUBLE
4793 Define this macro if @code{float} arguments cannot be passed to library
4794 routines (so they must be converted to @code{double}). This macro
4795 affects both how library calls are generated and how the library
4796 routines in @file{libgcc.a} accept their arguments. It is useful on
4797 machines where floating and fixed point arguments are passed
4798 differently, such as the i860.
4799
4800 @findex NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
4801 @item NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
4802 Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
4803 the calling convention of the NeXT system. This calling convention
4804 involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
4805 at once to the method-lookup library function.
4806
4807 The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
4808 to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
4809 @end table
4810
4811 @node Addressing Modes
4812 @section Addressing Modes
4813 @cindex addressing modes
4814
4815 @c prevent bad page break with this line
4816 This is about addressing modes.
4817
4818 @table @code
4819 @findex HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
4820 @findex HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
4821 @findex HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
4822 @findex HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
4823 @item HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
4824 @itemx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
4825 @itemx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
4826 @itemx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
4827 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
4828 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
4829
4830 @findex HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
4831 @findex HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
4832 @item HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
4833 @itemx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
4834 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
4835 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
4836 the size of the memory operand.
4837
4838 @findex HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
4839 @findex HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
4840 @item HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
4841 @itemx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
4842 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
4843 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
4844
4845 @findex CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P
4846 @item CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
4847 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
4848 is a valid address. On most machines, this can be defined as
4849 @code{CONSTANT_P (@var{x})}, but a few machines are more restrictive
4850 in which constant addresses are supported.
4851
4852 @findex CONSTANT_P
4853 @code{CONSTANT_P} accepts integer-values expressions whose values are
4854 not explicitly known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and
4855 @code{high} expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in
4856 addition to @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
4857
4858 @findex MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
4859 @item MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
4860 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
4861 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
4862 the maximum number that @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} would ever
4863 accept.
4864
4865 @findex GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS
4866 @item GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
4867 A C compound statement with a conditional @code{goto @var{label};}
4868 executed if @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory address on the
4869 target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
4870
4871 It usually pays to define several simpler macros to serve as
4872 subroutines for this one. Otherwise it may be too complicated to
4873 understand.
4874
4875 This macro must exist in two variants: a strict variant and a
4876 non-strict one. The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It
4877 must be defined so that any pseudo-register that has not been
4878 allocated a hard register is considered a memory reference. In
4879 contexts where some kind of register is required, a pseudo-register
4880 with no hard register must be rejected.
4881
4882 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
4883 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
4884 register is required.
4885
4886 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
4887 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
4888 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
4889 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant
4890 in that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
4891
4892 Subroutines to check for acceptable registers for various purposes (one
4893 for base registers, one for index registers, and so on) are typically
4894 among the subroutines used to define @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}.
4895 Then only these subroutine macros need have two variants; the higher
4896 levels of macros may be the same whether strict or not.
4897
4898 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
4899 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
4900 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
4901 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
4902 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
4903
4904 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
4905 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
4906 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
4907 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
4908 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
4909
4910 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
4911 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
4912 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
4913 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
4914 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
4915 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
4916 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
4917 Format}.
4918
4919 @findex saveable_obstack
4920 The best way to modify the name string is by adding text to the
4921 beginning, with suitable punctuation to prevent any ambiguity. Allocate
4922 the new name in @code{saveable_obstack}. You will have to modify
4923 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to remove and decode the added text and
4924 output the name accordingly, and define @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING}
4925 to access the original name string.
4926
4927 You can check the information stored here into the @code{symbol_ref} in
4928 the definitions of the macros @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} and
4929 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
4930
4931 @findex REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P
4932 @item REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{x})
4933 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} (assumed to be a @code{reg}
4934 RTX) is valid for use as a base register. For hard registers, it
4935 should always accept those which the hardware permits and reject the
4936 others. Whether the macro accepts or rejects pseudo registers must be
4937 controlled by @code{REG_OK_STRICT} as described above. This usually
4938 requires two variant definitions, of which @code{REG_OK_STRICT}
4939 controls the one actually used.
4940
4941 @findex REG_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P
4942 @item REG_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{x}, @var{mode})
4943 A C expression that is just like @code{REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
4944 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
4945 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
4946 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
4947 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
4948 @code{REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
4949
4950 @findex REG_OK_FOR_INDEX_P
4951 @item REG_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{x})
4952 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} (assumed to be a @code{reg}
4953 RTX) is valid for use as an index register.
4954
4955 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
4956 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
4957 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
4958 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
4959 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
4960 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
4961 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
4962 only if neither labeling works.
4963
4964 @findex FIND_BASE_TERM
4965 @item FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
4966 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x}.
4967 This macro is used in only one place: `find_base_term' in alias.c.
4968
4969 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
4970 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
4971
4972 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
4973 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
4974
4975 @findex LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
4976 @item LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{oldx}, @var{mode}, @var{win})
4977 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x} with a valid
4978 memory address for an operand of mode @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a
4979 C statement label elsewhere in the code; the macro definition may use
4980
4981 @example
4982 GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{win});
4983 @end example
4984
4985 @noindent
4986 to avoid further processing if the address has become legitimate.
4987
4988 @findex break_out_memory_refs
4989 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
4990 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
4991 @var{x}.
4992
4993 The code generated by this macro should not alter the substructure of
4994 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
4995 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
4996
4997 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
4998 address. The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In
4999 fact, it is safe for this macro to do nothing. But often a
5000 machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5001
5002 @findex LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS
5003 @item LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5004 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5005 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5006 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5007 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5008 performance reasons.
5009
5010 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5011 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5012 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5013 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5014 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5015 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5016 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5017 be shared.
5018
5019 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5020 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5021 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5022 of reload internals.
5023
5024 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5025 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5026 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5027
5028 @findex push_reload
5029 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5030 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5031 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5032
5033 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5034 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5035 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5036 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5037 @code{push_reload}.
5038
5039 @findex strict_memory_address_p
5040 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5041 the address has become legitimate.
5042
5043 @findex copy_rtx
5044 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5045 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that is unshares only a
5046 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5047 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5048 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5049 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5050
5051 @findex GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS
5052 @item GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
5053 A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5054 @var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5055 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5056 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5057 but not others.
5058
5059 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5060 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5061 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5062 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5063
5064 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5065
5066 @findex LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P
5067 @item LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5068 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for
5069 an immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5070 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this. In fact,
5071 @samp{1} is a suitable definition for this macro on machines where
5072 anything @code{CONSTANT_P} is valid.
5073 @end table
5074
5075 @node Condition Code
5076 @section Condition Code Status
5077 @cindex condition code status
5078
5079 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5080 This describes the condition code status.
5081
5082 @findex cc_status
5083 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5084 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5085 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5086 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5087 currently based, and several standard flags.
5088
5089 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5090 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5091 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5092
5093 @table @code
5094 @findex CC_STATUS_MDEP
5095 @item CC_STATUS_MDEP
5096 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5097 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5098
5099 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5100
5101 @findex CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5102 @item CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5103 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5104 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5105 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5106 define this macro to initialize it.
5107
5108 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5109
5110 @findex NOTICE_UPDATE_CC
5111 @item NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5112 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5113 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5114 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5115 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5116 set @code{(cc0)}.
5117
5118 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5119
5120 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5121 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5122 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5123 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5124 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5125 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5126 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5127 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5128 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5129 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5130 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5131 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5132 condition code value.
5133
5134 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5135 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5136 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5137 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5138 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5139 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5140 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5141
5142 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5143 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5144 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5145 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5146
5147 @findex EXTRA_CC_MODES
5148 @item EXTRA_CC_MODES
5149 Condition codes are represented in registers by machine modes of class
5150 @code{MODE_CC}. By default, there is just one mode, @code{CCmode}, with
5151 this class. If you need more such modes, create a file named
5152 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} in your @file{config/@var{machine}}
5153 directory (@pxref{Back End, , Anatomy of a Target Back End}), containing
5154 a list of these modes. Each entry in the list should be a call to the
5155 macro @code{CC}. This macro takes one argument, which is the name of
5156 the mode: it should begin with @samp{CC}. Do not put quotation marks
5157 around the name, or include the trailing @samp{mode}; these are
5158 automatically added. There should not be anything else in the file
5159 except comments.
5160
5161 A sample @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} file might look like this:
5162
5163 @smallexample
5164 CC (CC_NOOV) /* @r{Comparison only valid if there was no overflow.} */
5165 CC (CCFP) /* @r{Floating point comparison that cannot trap.} */
5166 CC (CCFPE) /* @r{Floating point comparison that may trap.} */
5167 @end smallexample
5168
5169 When you create this file, the macro @code{EXTRA_CC_MODES} is
5170 automatically defined by @command{configure}, with value @samp{1}.
5171
5172 @findex SELECT_CC_MODE
5173 @item SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5174 Returns a mode from class @code{MODE_CC} to be used when comparison
5175 operation code @var{op} is applied to rtx @var{x} and @var{y}. For
5176 example, on the SPARC, @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} is defined as (see
5177 @pxref{Jump Patterns} for a description of the reason for this
5178 definition)
5179
5180 @smallexample
5181 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
5182 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
5183 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
5184 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
5185 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
5186 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5187 @end smallexample
5188
5189 You need not define this macro if @code{EXTRA_CC_MODES} is not defined.
5190
5191 @findex CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON
5192 @item CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
5193 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
5194 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
5195 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
5196 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
5197
5198 On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
5199 required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
5200 and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
5201 comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
5202 @var{op1} as required.
5203
5204 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
5205 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
5206 @file{md} file.
5207
5208 You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
5209 code or operands.
5210
5211 @findex REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE
5212 @item REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
5213 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
5214 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
5215 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
5216 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
5217
5218 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
5219 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
5220 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
5221 inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
5222
5223 @smallexample
5224 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
5225 @end smallexample
5226
5227 @findex REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
5228 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
5229 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
5230 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
5231 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
5232 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
5233 freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
5234 like:
5235
5236 @smallexample
5237 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
5238 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
5239 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
5240 @end smallexample
5241
5242 @findex REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P
5243 @item REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{code1}, @var{code2})
5244 A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
5245 @var{code1} is the inverse of @var{code2} and vice versa. Define this to
5246 return 0 if the target has conditional execution predicates that cannot be
5247 reversed safely. If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as
5248 follows:
5249
5250 @smallexample
5251 #define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
5252 ((x) == reverse_condition (y))
5253 @end smallexample
5254
5255 @end table
5256
5257 @node Costs
5258 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
5259 @cindex costs of instructions
5260 @cindex relative costs
5261 @cindex speed of instructions
5262
5263 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
5264 on the target machine.
5265
5266 @table @code
5267 @findex CONST_COSTS
5268 @item CONST_COSTS (@var{x}, @var{code}, @var{outer_code})
5269 A part of a C @code{switch} statement that describes the relative costs
5270 of constant RTL expressions. It must contain @code{case} labels for
5271 expression codes @code{const_int}, @code{const}, @code{symbol_ref},
5272 @code{label_ref} and @code{const_double}. Each case must ultimately
5273 reach a @code{return} statement to return the relative cost of the use
5274 of that kind of constant value in an expression. The cost may depend on
5275 the precise value of the constant, which is available for examination in
5276 @var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression in which it is contained,
5277 found in @var{outer_code}.
5278
5279 @var{code} is the expression code---redundant, since it can be
5280 obtained with @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
5281
5282 @findex RTX_COSTS
5283 @findex COSTS_N_INSNS
5284 @item RTX_COSTS (@var{x}, @var{code}, @var{outer_code})
5285 Like @code{CONST_COSTS} but applies to nonconstant RTL expressions.
5286 This can be used, for example, to indicate how costly a multiply
5287 instruction is. In writing this macro, you can use the construct
5288 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
5289 instructions. @var{outer_code} is the code of the expression in which
5290 @var{x} is contained.
5291
5292 This macro is optional; do not define it if the default cost assumptions
5293 are adequate for the target machine.
5294
5295 @findex DEFAULT_RTX_COSTS
5296 @item DEFAULT_RTX_COSTS (@var{x}, @var{code}, @var{outer_code})
5297 This macro, if defined, is called for any case not handled by the
5298 @code{RTX_COSTS} or @code{CONST_COSTS} macros. This eliminates the need
5299 to put case labels into the macro, but the code, or any functions it
5300 calls, must assume that the RTL in @var{x} could be of any type that has
5301 not already been handled. The arguments are the same as for
5302 @code{RTX_COSTS}, and the macro should execute a return statement giving
5303 the cost of any RTL expressions that it can handle. The default cost
5304 calculation is used for any RTL for which this macro does not return a
5305 value.
5306
5307 This macro is optional; do not define it if the default cost assumptions
5308 are adequate for the target machine.
5309
5310 @findex ADDRESS_COST
5311 @item ADDRESS_COST (@var{address})
5312 An expression giving the cost of an addressing mode that contains
5313 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
5314 the @var{address} expression and the @code{CONST_COSTS} values.
5315
5316 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
5317 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
5318 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
5319 all addresses will have equal costs.
5320
5321 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
5322 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
5323 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
5324
5325 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
5326 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
5327 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
5328 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
5329 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
5330 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
5331 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
5332 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
5333
5334 Similar use of this macro is made in strength reduction of loops.
5335
5336 @var{address} need not be valid as an address. In such a case, the cost
5337 is not relevant and can be any value; invalid addresses need not be
5338 assigned a different cost.
5339
5340 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
5341 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
5342 @code{ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to be live
5343 over a region of code where only one would have been if
5344 @code{ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect should
5345 be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs should
5346 probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of registers
5347 on machines with lots of registers.
5348
5349 This macro will normally either not be defined or be defined as a
5350 constant.
5351
5352 @findex REGISTER_MOVE_COST
5353 @item REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
5354 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
5355 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
5356 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
5357 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
5358 that.
5359
5360 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
5361 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
5362 registers if they are not general registers.
5363
5364 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
5365 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
5366 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
5367 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
5368 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
5369 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
5370
5371 @findex MEMORY_MOVE_COST
5372 @item MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
5373 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
5374 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
5375 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
5376 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
5377 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
5378 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
5379
5380 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
5381 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
5382 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
5383 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
5384 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
5385 reflect the actual cost of the move.
5386
5387 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
5388 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
5389 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
5390 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
5391 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
5392 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
5393 are the same as to this macro.
5394
5395 @findex BRANCH_COST
5396 @item BRANCH_COST
5397 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
5398 the default; other values are interpreted relative to that.
5399 @end table
5400
5401 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
5402 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
5403 ordinarily expect.
5404
5405 @table @code
5406 @findex SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
5407 @item SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
5408 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
5409 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
5410 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
5411 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
5412 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
5413
5414 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
5415 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
5416 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
5417 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
5418 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
5419 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
5420
5421 @findex SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS
5422 @item SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
5423 Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
5424 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
5425 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
5426 handler.
5427
5428 When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
5429 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
5430 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
5431 Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
5432 cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
5433
5434 If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
5435 this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
5436 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
5437
5438 @findex DONT_REDUCE_ADDR
5439 @item DONT_REDUCE_ADDR
5440 Define this macro to inhibit strength reduction of memory addresses.
5441 (On some machines, such strength reduction seems to do harm rather
5442 than good.)
5443
5444 @findex MOVE_RATIO
5445 @item MOVE_RATIO
5446 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
5447 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
5448 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
5449 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
5450
5451 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
5452 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
5453 the number of such sequences.
5454
5455 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
5456
5457 @findex MOVE_BY_PIECES_P
5458 @item MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
5459 A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
5460 copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
5461 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
5462 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
5463
5464 @findex MOVE_MAX_PIECES
5465 @item MOVE_MAX_PIECES
5466 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
5467 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
5468
5469 @findex CLEAR_RATIO
5470 @item CLEAR_RATIO
5471 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
5472 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
5473 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
5474 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
5475
5476 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
5477
5478 @findex CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P
5479 @item CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
5480 A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
5481 to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
5482 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
5483 than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
5484
5485 @findex STORE_BY_PIECES_P
5486 @item STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
5487 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
5488 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some other
5489 mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when storing
5490 values other than constant zero and by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
5491 when called with a constant source string.
5492 Defaults to @code{MOVE_BY_PIECES_P}.
5493
5494 @findex USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT
5495 @item USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5496 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
5497 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5498 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
5499
5500 @findex USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT
5501 @item USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5502 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
5503 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5504 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
5505
5506 @findex USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT
5507 @item USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5508 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
5509 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5510 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
5511
5512 @findex USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT
5513 @item USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5514 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
5515 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5516 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
5517
5518 @findex USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT
5519 @item USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5520 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
5521 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5522 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
5523
5524 @findex USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT
5525 @item USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5526 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
5527 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5528 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
5529
5530 @findex USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT
5531 @item USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5532 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
5533 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5534 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
5535
5536 @findex USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT
5537 @item USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5538 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
5539 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5540 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
5541
5542 @findex NO_FUNCTION_CSE
5543 @item NO_FUNCTION_CSE
5544 Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
5545 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
5546
5547 @findex NO_RECURSIVE_FUNCTION_CSE
5548 @item NO_RECURSIVE_FUNCTION_CSE
5549 Define this macro if it is as good or better for a function to call
5550 itself with an explicit address than to call an address kept in a
5551 register.
5552 @end table
5553
5554 @node Scheduling
5555 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
5556
5557 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
5558 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
5559 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
5560 them: try the first ones in this list first.
5561
5562 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
5563 This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
5564 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
5565 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
5566 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
5567 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
5568 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
5569 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
5570 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
5571 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
5572
5573 For the automaton based pipeline interface, you could define this hook
5574 to return the value of the macro @code{MAX_DFA_ISSUE_RATE}.
5575 @end deftypefn
5576
5577 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{more})
5578 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
5579 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
5580 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
5581 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
5582 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
5583 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
5584 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
5585 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
5586 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
5587 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
5588 was scheduled.
5589 @end deftypefn
5590
5591 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx @var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
5592 This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
5593 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
5594 dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
5595 is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
5596 to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
5597 that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
5598 data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
5599 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
5600 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
5601 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
5602 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
5603 @pxref{Automaton pipeline description}.
5604 @end deftypefn
5605
5606 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{priority})
5607 This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
5608 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Reduce the priority to
5609 execute @var{insn} earlier, increase the priority to execute @var{insn}
5610 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
5611 scheduling priorities of insns.
5612 @end deftypefn
5613
5614 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
5615 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
5616 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
5617 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
5618 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
5619 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
5620 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
5621 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
5622 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
5623 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
5624 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp}-1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
5625 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
5626 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
5627 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
5628 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
5629 @end deftypefn
5630
5631 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_ready}, @var{clock})
5632 Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
5633 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
5634 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
5635 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
5636 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
5637 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
5638 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
5639 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
5640 @end deftypefn
5641
5642 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx @var{head}, rtx @var{tail})
5643 This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
5644 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
5645 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
5646 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
5647 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
5648 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
5649 calculated.
5650 @end deftypefn
5651
5652 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
5653 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
5654 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
5655 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
5656 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
5657 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
5658 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
5659 scratch space if it is needed, e.g. by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
5660 @end deftypefn
5661
5662 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
5663 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
5664 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
5665 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
5666 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
5667 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
5668 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
5669 @end deftypefn
5670
5671 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_USE_DFA_PIPELINE_INTERFACE (void)
5672 This hook is called many times during insn scheduling. If the hook
5673 returns nonzero, the automaton based pipeline description is used for
5674 insn scheduling. Otherwise the traditional pipeline description is
5675 used. The default is usage of the traditional pipeline description.
5676
5677 You should also remember that to simplify the insn scheduler sources
5678 an empty traditional pipeline description interface is generated even
5679 if there is no a traditional pipeline description in the @file{.md}
5680 file. The same is true for the automaton based pipeline description.
5681 That means that you should be accurate in defining the hook.
5682 @end deftypefn
5683
5684 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
5685 The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
5686 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
5687 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
5688 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
5689 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
5690 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
5691 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
5692 @end deftypefn
5693
5694 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
5695 The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
5696 @end deftypefn
5697
5698 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
5699 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
5700 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
5701 simulated processor cycle finishes.
5702 @end deftypefn
5703
5704 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
5705 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
5706 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
5707 @end deftypefn
5708
5709 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
5710 This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
5711 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
5712 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
5713 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
5714 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
5715 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
5716 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
5717 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
5718 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
5719 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
5720
5721 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
5722 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
5723 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
5724 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
5725 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
5726 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
5727 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
5728 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
5729 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
5730
5731 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
5732 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
5733 schedules to choose the best one.
5734
5735 The default is no multipass scheduling.
5736 @end deftypefn
5737
5738 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx)
5739
5740 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
5741 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
5742 zero for insn passed as the parameter, the insn will be not chosen to
5743 be issued.
5744
5745 The default is that any ready insns can be choosen to be issued.
5746 @end deftypefn
5747
5748 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *, int, rtx, int, int, int *)
5749
5750 This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing insn passed
5751 as the third parameter on given cycle. If the hook returns nonzero,
5752 the insn is not issued on given processors cycle. Instead of that,
5753 the processor cycle is advanced. If the value passed through the last
5754 parameter is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
5755 start as usually. The first parameter passes file for debugging
5756 output. The second one passes the scheduler verbose level of the
5757 debugging output. The forth and the fifth parameter values are
5758 correspondingly processor cycle on which the previous insn has been
5759 issued and the current processor cycle.
5760 @end deftypefn
5761
5762 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_BUBBLES (void)
5763 The @acronym{DFA}-based scheduler could take the insertion of nop
5764 operations for better insn scheduling into account. It can be done
5765 only if the multi-pass insn scheduling works (see hook
5766 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD}).
5767
5768 Let us consider a @acronym{VLIW} processor insn with 3 slots. Each
5769 insn can be placed only in one of the three slots. We have 3 ready
5770 insns @var{A}, @var{B}, and @var{C}. @var{A} and @var{C} can be
5771 placed only in the 1st slot, @var{B} can be placed only in the 3rd
5772 slot. We described the automaton which does not permit empty slot
5773 gaps between insns (usually such description is simpler). Without
5774 this code the scheduler would place each insn in 3 separate
5775 @acronym{VLIW} insns. If the scheduler places a nop insn into the 2nd
5776 slot, it could place the 3 insns into 2 @acronym{VLIW} insns. What is
5777 the nop insn is returned by hook @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_BUBBLE}. Hook
5778 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_BUBBLES} can be used to initialize or
5779 create the nop insns.
5780
5781 You should remember that the scheduler does not insert the nop insns.
5782 It is not wise because of the following optimizations. The scheduler
5783 only considers such possibility to improve the result schedule. The
5784 nop insns should be inserted lately, e.g. on the final phase.
5785 @end deftypefn
5786
5787 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_BUBBLE (int @var{index})
5788 This hook @samp{FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_SCHEDULING} is used to insert
5789 nop operations for better insn scheduling when @acronym{DFA}-based
5790 scheduler makes multipass insn scheduling (see also description of
5791 hook @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_BUBBLES}). This hook
5792 returns a nop insn with given @var{index}. The indexes start with
5793 zero. The hook should return @code{NULL} if there are no more nop
5794 insns with indexes greater than given index.
5795 @end deftypefn
5796
5797 Macros in the following table are generated by the program
5798 @file{genattr} and can be useful for writing the hooks.
5799
5800 @table @code
5801 @findex TRADITIONAL_PIPELINE_INTERFACE
5802 @item TRADITIONAL_PIPELINE_INTERFACE
5803 The macro definition is generated if there is a traditional pipeline
5804 description in @file{.md} file. You should also remember that to
5805 simplify the insn scheduler sources an empty traditional pipeline
5806 description interface is generated even if there is no a traditional
5807 pipeline description in the @file{.md} file. The macro can be used to
5808 distinguish the two types of the traditional interface.
5809
5810 @findex DFA_PIPELINE_INTERFACE
5811 @item DFA_PIPELINE_INTERFACE
5812 The macro definition is generated if there is an automaton pipeline
5813 description in @file{.md} file. You should also remember that to
5814 simplify the insn scheduler sources an empty automaton pipeline
5815 description interface is generated even if there is no an automaton
5816 pipeline description in the @file{.md} file. The macro can be used to
5817 distinguish the two types of the automaton interface.
5818
5819 @findex MAX_DFA_ISSUE_RATE
5820 @item MAX_DFA_ISSUE_RATE
5821 The macro definition is generated in the automaton based pipeline
5822 description interface. Its value is calculated from the automaton
5823 based pipeline description and is equal to maximal number of all insns
5824 described in constructions @samp{define_insn_reservation} which can be
5825 issued on the same processor cycle.
5826
5827 @end table
5828
5829 @node Sections
5830 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
5831 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
5832 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
5833
5834 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
5835 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
5836 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
5837 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
5838 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
5839 of sections.
5840
5841 The compiler must tell the assembler when to switch sections. These
5842 macros control what commands to output to tell the assembler this. You
5843 can also define additional sections.
5844
5845 @table @code
5846 @findex TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5847 @item TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5848 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
5849 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
5850 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
5851
5852 @findex TEXT_SECTION
5853 @item TEXT_SECTION
5854 A C statement that switches to the default section containing instructions.
5855 Normally this is not needed, as simply defining @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
5856 is enough. The MIPS port uses this to sort all functions after all data
5857 declarations.
5858
5859 @findex HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
5860 @item HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
5861 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
5862 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
5863 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
5864
5865 @findex UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
5866 @item UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
5867 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
5868 executed functions in the program.
5869
5870 @findex DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
5871 @item DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
5872 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
5873 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
5874 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
5875
5876 @findex READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
5877 @item READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
5878 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
5879 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
5880 data.
5881
5882 @findex READONLY_DATA_SECTION
5883 @item READONLY_DATA_SECTION
5884 A macro naming a function to call to switch to the proper section for
5885 read-only data. The default is to use @code{READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}
5886 if defined, else fall back to @code{text_section}.
5887
5888 The most common definition will be @code{data_section}, if the target
5889 does not have a special read-only data section, and does not put data
5890 in the text section.
5891
5892 @findex SHARED_SECTION_ASM_OP
5893 @item SHARED_SECTION_ASM_OP
5894 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5895 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5896 shared data. If not defined, @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP} will be used.
5897
5898 @findex BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5899 @item BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5900 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5901 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5902 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and neither
5903 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} nor @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are defined,
5904 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
5905 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
5906 used.
5907
5908 @findex SHARED_BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5909 @item SHARED_BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5910 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5911 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5912 uninitialized global shared data. If not defined, and
5913 @code{BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP} is, the latter will be used.
5914
5915 @findex INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5916 @item INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5917 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5918 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5919 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
5920 not exist.
5921
5922 @findex FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
5923 @item FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
5924 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5925 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5926 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
5927 not exist.
5928
5929 @findex CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION
5930 @item CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
5931 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
5932 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
5933 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
5934 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
5935 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
5936 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
5937 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
5938 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
5939 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
5940
5941 @findex FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
5942 @item FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
5943 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
5944 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
5945 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
5946 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
5947
5948 @findex EXTRA_SECTIONS
5949 @findex in_text
5950 @findex in_data
5951 @item EXTRA_SECTIONS
5952 A list of names for sections other than the standard two, which are
5953 @code{in_text} and @code{in_data}. You need not define this macro
5954 on a system with no other sections (that GCC needs to use).
5955
5956 @findex EXTRA_SECTION_FUNCTIONS
5957 @findex text_section
5958 @findex data_section
5959 @item EXTRA_SECTION_FUNCTIONS
5960 One or more functions to be defined in @file{varasm.c}. These
5961 functions should do jobs analogous to those of @code{text_section} and
5962 @code{data_section}, for your additional sections. Do not define this
5963 macro if you do not define @code{EXTRA_SECTIONS}.
5964
5965 @findex JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
5966 @item JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
5967 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
5968 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
5969 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
5970 readonly data section is used.
5971
5972 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
5973 @end table
5974
5975 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
5976 Switches to the appropriate section for output of @var{exp}. You can
5977 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
5978 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
5979 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
5980 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
5981 Select the section by calling @code{data_section} or one of the
5982 alternatives for other sections. @var{align} is the constant alignment
5983 in bits.
5984
5985 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
5986 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
5987 @end deftypefn
5988
5989 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
5990 Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
5991 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
5992 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
5993 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
5994
5995 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
5996 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
5997 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
5998 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
5999 @end deftypefn
6000
6001 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
6002 Switches to the appropriate section for output of constant pool entry
6003 @var{x} in @var{mode}. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
6004 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
6005 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. Select the section by calling
6006 @code{readonly_data_section} or one of the alternatives for other
6007 sections. @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
6008
6009 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
6010 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
6011 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
6012 @end deftypefn
6013
6014 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
6015 Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
6016 treated differently depending on something about the variable or
6017 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
6018
6019 The hook is executed under two circumstances. One is immediately after
6020 the rtl for @var{decl} that represents a variable or a function has been
6021 created and stored in @code{DECL_RTL(@var{decl})}. The value of the rtl
6022 will be a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. The other is
6023 immediately after the rtl for @var{decl} that represents a constant has
6024 been created and stored in @code{TREE_CST_RTL (@var{decl})}. The macro
6025 is called once for each distinct constant in a source file.
6026
6027 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
6028 that @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
6029 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
6030 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
6031 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
6032
6033 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
6034 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record a flag in the
6035 @code{symbol_ref} (such as @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}) or to store a
6036 modified name string in the @code{symbol_ref} (if one bit is not
6037 enough information).
6038 @end deftypefn
6039
6040 @deftypefn {Target Hook} const char *TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *name)
6041 Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
6042 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
6043 may have added.
6044 @end deftypefn
6045
6046 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (tree @var{exp})
6047 Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
6048 The default version of this hook always returns false.
6049 @end deftypefn
6050
6051 @deftypevar {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
6052 Contains the value true if the target places read-only
6053 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
6054 @end deftypevar
6055
6056 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (tree @var{exp})
6057 Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
6058 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
6059 or executable image).
6060
6061 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
6062 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
6063 currently supported object file formats.
6064 @end deftypefn
6065
6066 @deftypevar {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
6067 Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
6068 The default value is false.
6069 @end deftypevar
6070
6071
6072 @node PIC
6073 @section Position Independent Code
6074 @cindex position independent code
6075 @cindex PIC
6076
6077 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
6078 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
6079 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the macros
6080 @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} and @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as
6081 well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You must modify the definition of
6082 @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate when the source operand
6083 contains a symbolic address. You may also need to alter the handling of
6084 switch statements so that they use relative addresses.
6085 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
6086 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
6087
6088 @table @code
6089 @findex PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
6090 @item PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
6091 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
6092 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
6093 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
6094 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
6095 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
6096 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
6097 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
6098 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
6099
6100 @findex PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
6101 @item PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
6102 Define this macro if the register defined by
6103 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. Do not define
6104 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
6105
6106 @findex FINALIZE_PIC
6107 @item FINALIZE_PIC
6108 By generating position-independent code, when two different programs (A
6109 and B) share a common library (libC.a), the text of the library can be
6110 shared whether or not the library is linked at the same address for both
6111 programs. In some of these environments, position-independent code
6112 requires not only the use of different addressing modes, but also
6113 special code to enable the use of these addressing modes.
6114
6115 The @code{FINALIZE_PIC} macro serves as a hook to emit these special
6116 codes once the function is being compiled into assembly code, but not
6117 before. (It is not done before, because in the case of compiling an
6118 inline function, it would lead to multiple PIC prologues being
6119 included in functions which used inline functions and were compiled to
6120 assembly language.)
6121
6122 @findex LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P
6123 @item LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
6124 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
6125 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
6126 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
6127 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
6128 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
6129 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
6130 position independent code.
6131 @end table
6132
6133 @node Assembler Format
6134 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
6135
6136 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
6137 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
6138 instructions do.
6139
6140 @menu
6141 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
6142 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
6143 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
6144 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
6145 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
6146 and termination routines.
6147 * Macros for Initialization::
6148 Specific macros that control the handling of
6149 initialization and termination routines.
6150 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
6151 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
6152 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
6153 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
6154 @end menu
6155
6156 @node File Framework
6157 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
6158 @cindex assembler format
6159 @cindex output of assembler code
6160
6161 @c prevent bad page break with this line
6162 This describes the overall framework of an assembler file.
6163
6164 @table @code
6165 @findex ASM_FILE_START
6166 @item ASM_FILE_START (@var{stream})
6167 A C expression which outputs to the stdio stream @var{stream}
6168 some appropriate text to go at the start of an assembler file.
6169
6170 Normally this macro is defined to output a line containing
6171 @samp{#NO_APP}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
6172 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it can save time by not
6173 checking for certain assembler constructs.
6174
6175 On systems that use SDB, it is necessary to output certain commands;
6176 see @file{attasm.h}.
6177
6178 @findex ASM_FILE_END
6179 @item ASM_FILE_END (@var{stream})
6180 A C expression which outputs to the stdio stream @var{stream}
6181 some appropriate text to go at the end of an assembler file.
6182
6183 If this macro is not defined, the default is to output nothing
6184 special at the end of the file. Most systems don't require any
6185 definition.
6186
6187 On systems that use SDB, it is necessary to output certain commands;
6188 see @file{attasm.h}.
6189
6190 @findex ASM_COMMENT_START
6191 @item ASM_COMMENT_START
6192 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
6193 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
6194 the end of the line.
6195
6196 @findex ASM_APP_ON
6197 @item ASM_APP_ON
6198 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
6199 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
6200 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
6201 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
6202 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
6203
6204 @findex ASM_APP_OFF
6205 @item ASM_APP_OFF
6206 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
6207 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
6208 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
6209 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
6210
6211 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
6212 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6213 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
6214 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
6215 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
6216
6217 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
6218 for the file format in use is appropriate.
6219
6220 @findex OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING
6221 @item OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
6222 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
6223 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
6224 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
6225 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
6226 of the filename using this macro.
6227
6228 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE
6229 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
6230 A C statement to output DBX or SDB debugging information before code
6231 for line number @var{line} of the current source file to the
6232 stdio stream @var{stream}.
6233
6234 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of debugging
6235 information for the debugger in use is appropriate.
6236
6237 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT
6238 @item ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
6239 A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
6240 @samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}. If this
6241 macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
6242
6243 @findex OBJC_PROLOGUE
6244 @item OBJC_PROLOGUE
6245 A C statement to output any assembler statements which are required to
6246 precede any Objective-C object definitions or message sending. The
6247 statement is executed only when compiling an Objective-C program.
6248 @end table
6249
6250 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, unsigned int @var{align})
6251 Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
6252 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
6253 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{align}
6254 is nonzero, it contains an alignment in bytes to be used for the section,
6255 otherwise some target default should be used. Only targets that must
6256 specify an alignment within the section directive need pay attention to
6257 @var{align} -- we will still use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}.
6258 @end deftypefn
6259
6260 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
6261 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
6262 @end deftypefn
6263
6264 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
6265 Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
6266 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
6267 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
6268 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
6269
6270 The default version if this function handles choosing code vs data,
6271 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
6272 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
6273 set via @code{__attribute__}.
6274 @end deftypefn
6275
6276 @need 2000
6277 @node Data Output
6278 @subsection Output of Data
6279
6280
6281 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
6282 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
6283 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
6284 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
6285 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
6286 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
6287 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
6288 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
6289 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
6290 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
6291 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
6292 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
6293 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
6294 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
6295
6296 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
6297 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
6298 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
6299 @end deftypevr
6300
6301 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
6302 The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
6303 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
6304 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
6305 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
6306 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
6307 split the object into smaller parts.
6308
6309 The default implementation of this hook will use the
6310 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
6311 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
6312 @end deftypefn
6313
6314 @table @code
6315 @findex OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA
6316 @item OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
6317 A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
6318 @code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
6319 @var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to
6320 allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
6321
6322 If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
6323 @code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed. If it
6324 prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
6325 @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
6326
6327 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII
6328 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
6329 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
6330 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
6331 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
6332 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
6333
6334 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
6335 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
6336 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
6337
6338 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC
6339 @item ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
6340 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
6341 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
6342 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
6343
6344 @findex CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
6345 @item CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
6346 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
6347 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
6348 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
6349 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
6350 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
6351 pool before the function.
6352
6353 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE
6354 @item ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
6355 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
6356 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
6357 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
6358 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
6359 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
6360 immediately after this call.
6361
6362 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
6363 not be defined.
6364
6365 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY
6366 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
6367 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
6368 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
6369 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
6370
6371 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
6372 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
6373 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
6374 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
6375 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
6376 alignment.
6377
6378 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
6379 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
6380 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
6381 Here is how to do this:
6382
6383 @example
6384 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
6385 @end example
6386
6387 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
6388 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
6389 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
6390
6391 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
6392
6393 @findex CONSTANT_AFTER_FUNCTION_P
6394 @item CONSTANT_AFTER_FUNCTION_P (@var{exp})
6395 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if the constant
6396 @var{exp}, of type @code{tree}, should be output after the code for a
6397 function. The compiler will normally output all constants before the
6398 function; you need not define this macro if this is OK@.
6399
6400 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE
6401 @item ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
6402 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
6403 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
6404 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
6405 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
6406 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
6407
6408 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
6409 define this macro.
6410
6411 @findex IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR
6412 @item IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C})
6413 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
6414 used as a logical line separator by the assembler.
6415
6416 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
6417 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
6418 @end table
6419
6420 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
6421 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
6422 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
6423 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
6424 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
6425 @end deftypevr
6426
6427 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
6428 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
6429
6430 @table @code
6431 @item REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
6432 @itemx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
6433 @itemx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
6434 @findex REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE
6435 @findex REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE
6436 @findex REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE
6437 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the target's
6438 floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in the variable
6439 @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE}, this variable should
6440 be a simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
6441 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined by
6442 the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of it
6443 go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds 32
6444 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits on the
6445 host machine.
6446
6447 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
6448 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
6449 machine's memory.
6450 @end table
6451
6452 @node Uninitialized Data
6453 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
6454
6455 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
6456 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
6457
6458 @table @code
6459 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON
6460 @item ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6461 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6462 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
6463 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
6464 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
6465
6466 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
6467 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
6468 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
6469
6470 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
6471 common global variables are output.
6472
6473 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON
6474 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6475 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
6476 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
6477 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
6478 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
6479 as the number of bits.
6480
6481 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON
6482 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6483 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
6484 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
6485 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
6486 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
6487 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
6488 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
6489
6490 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_COMMON
6491 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6492 If defined, it is similar to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, except that it
6493 is used when @var{name} is shared. If not defined, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}
6494 will be used.
6495
6496 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_BSS
6497 @item ASM_OUTPUT_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6498 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6499 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
6500 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
6501 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
6502
6503 Try to use function @code{asm_output_bss} defined in @file{varasm.c} when
6504 defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
6505 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
6506 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
6507 the name, and a newline.
6508
6509 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized global
6510 variables are output. This macro exists to properly support languages like
6511 C++ which do not have @code{common} data. However, this macro currently
6512 is not defined for all targets. If this macro and
6513 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are not defined then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}
6514 or @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} or
6515 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON} is used.
6516
6517 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS
6518 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6519 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} except takes the required alignment as a
6520 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
6521 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, and gives you more flexibility in
6522 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
6523 as the number of bits.
6524
6525 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
6526 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro.
6527
6528 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_BSS
6529 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6530 If defined, it is similar to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, except that it
6531 is used when @var{name} is shared. If not defined, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}
6532 will be used.
6533
6534 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL
6535 @item ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6536 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6537 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
6538 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
6539 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
6540
6541 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
6542 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
6543 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
6544
6545 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
6546 static variables are output.
6547
6548 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL
6549 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6550 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
6551 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
6552 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
6553 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
6554 as the number of bits.
6555
6556 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL
6557 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6558 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
6559 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
6560 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
6561 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
6562 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
6563 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
6564
6565 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_LOCAL
6566 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6567 If defined, it is similar to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, except that it
6568 is used when @var{name} is shared. If not defined, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}
6569 will be used.
6570 @end table
6571
6572 @node Label Output
6573 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
6574
6575 @c prevent bad page break with this line
6576 This is about outputting labels.
6577
6578 @table @code
6579 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL
6580 @findex assemble_name
6581 @item ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6582 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6583 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
6584 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
6585 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
6586 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
6587 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
6588
6589 @findex SIZE_ASM_OP
6590 @item SIZE_ASM_OP
6591 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
6592 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
6593 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
6594 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
6595
6596 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
6597 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
6598 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
6599 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
6600 define this macro.
6601
6602 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE
6603 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
6604 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6605 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
6606 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
6607 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
6608 provided.
6609
6610 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE
6611 @item ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6612 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6613 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
6614 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
6615 address.
6616
6617 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
6618 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
6619 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
6620 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
6621 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
6622 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
6623
6624 @findex TYPE_ASM_OP
6625 @item TYPE_ASM_OP
6626 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
6627 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
6628 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
6629 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
6630
6631 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
6632 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
6633 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
6634 types at all, do not define this macro.
6635
6636 @findex TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
6637 @item TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
6638 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
6639 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
6640 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
6641 the default is not to define this macro.
6642
6643 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
6644 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
6645 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
6646 types at all, do not define this macro.
6647
6648 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE
6649 @item ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
6650 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6651 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
6652 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
6653 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
6654 you should not count on this.
6655
6656 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
6657 definition of this macro is provided.
6658
6659 @findex ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME
6660 @item ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
6661 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6662 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
6663 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
6664 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
6665 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
6666 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
6667
6668 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
6669 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
6670
6671 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
6672 of this macro.
6673
6674 @findex ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE
6675 @item ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
6676 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6677 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
6678 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
6679 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
6680 representing the function.
6681
6682 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
6683
6684 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
6685 of this macro.
6686
6687 @findex ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME
6688 @item ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
6689 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6690 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
6691 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
6692 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
6693 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
6694
6695 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
6696 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
6697
6698 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
6699 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
6700
6701 @findex ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL
6702 @item ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
6703 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6704 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
6705 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
6706
6707 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
6708 nothing.
6709
6710 @findex ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT
6711 @item ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
6712 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
6713 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
6714 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
6715 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
6716 something about the size of the object.
6717
6718 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
6719 nothing.
6720
6721 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
6722 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
6723 @end table
6724
6725 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
6726 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
6727 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
6728 that is, available for reference from other files.
6729
6730 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
6731 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
6732 @end deftypefn
6733
6734 @table @code
6735 @findex ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL
6736 @item ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6737 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6738 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
6739 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
6740 no other definition is available. Use the expression
6741 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
6742 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
6743 for making that name weak, and a newline.
6744
6745 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
6746 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
6747 macro.
6748
6749 @findex ASM_WEAKEN_DECL
6750 @item ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
6751 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
6752 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
6753 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
6754 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
6755 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
6756 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
6757 to make @var{name} weak.
6758
6759 @findex SUPPORTS_WEAK
6760 @item SUPPORTS_WEAK
6761 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
6762
6763 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
6764 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
6765 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is
6766 @samp{0}. Define this macro if you want to control weak symbol support
6767 with a compiler flag such as @option{-melf}.
6768
6769 @findex MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
6770 @item MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY
6771 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
6772 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
6773 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
6774 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
6775 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
6776 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
6777
6778 @findex SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
6779 @item SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
6780 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
6781 semantics.
6782
6783 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
6784 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
6785 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
6786 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
6787 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
6788 be emitted as one-only.
6789
6790 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{visibility})
6791 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
6792 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
6793 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
6794 @end deftypefn
6795
6796 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL
6797 @item ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
6798 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6799 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
6800 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
6801 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
6802 declaration.
6803
6804 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
6805 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
6806
6807 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
6808 @item ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (@var{stream}, @var{symref})
6809 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output on @var{stream} an assembler
6810 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
6811 library function is given by @var{symref}, which has type @code{rtx} and
6812 is a @code{symbol_ref}.
6813
6814 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
6815 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
6816
6817 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF
6818 @item ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6819 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6820 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
6821 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
6822 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
6823 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
6824
6825 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF
6826 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
6827 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
6828 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
6829 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
6830 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
6831 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
6832
6833 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF
6834 @item ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
6835 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
6836 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
6837 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
6838 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
6839 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
6840 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
6841 being taken.
6842 @end table
6843
6844 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
6845 A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
6846 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
6847
6848 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
6849 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
6850 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
6851
6852 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
6853 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
6854 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
6855 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
6856 convention your system uses, and follow it.
6857
6858 The default version of this function utilizes ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL.
6859
6860 @end deftypefn
6861
6862 @table @code
6863 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL
6864 @item ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
6865 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
6866 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
6867 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
6868 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
6869 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
6870 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
6871 bundles.
6872
6873 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
6874 used.
6875
6876 @findex ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL
6877 @item ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
6878 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
6879 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
6880
6881 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
6882 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
6883 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
6884
6885 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
6886 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
6887 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
6888 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
6889 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
6890 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
6891 you should know what it does on your machine.)
6892
6893 @findex ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME
6894 @item ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
6895 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
6896 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
6897 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
6898 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
6899
6900 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
6901 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
6902 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
6903 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
6904 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
6905 internal static variables in different scopes.
6906
6907 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
6908 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
6909 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
6910 between the name and the number will suffice.
6911
6912 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
6913 which is correct for most systems.
6914
6915 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEF
6916 @item ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
6917 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6918 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
6919
6920 @findex SET_ASM_OP
6921 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
6922 correct for most systems.
6923
6924 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS
6925 @item ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
6926 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6927 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
6928 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
6929 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
6930 the tree nodes are available.
6931
6932 @findex SET_ASM_OP
6933 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
6934 correct for most systems.
6935
6936 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS
6937 @item ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
6938 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6939 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
6940 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
6941 an undefined weak symbol.
6942
6943 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
6944 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
6945
6946 @findex OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL
6947 @item OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
6948 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
6949 Objective-C methods.
6950
6951 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
6952 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
6953 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
6954 @samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
6955
6956 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
6957 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
6958 systems define other ways of computing names.
6959
6960 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
6961 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
6962 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
6963 50 characters extra.
6964
6965 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
6966 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
6967 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
6968 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
6969
6970 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
6971 macro to provide more human-readable names.
6972
6973 @findex ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE
6974 @item ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6975 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6976 @var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
6977 Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets whose
6978 linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
6979
6980 @findex ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE
6981 @item ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6982 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6983 @var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
6984 unresolved Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets
6985 whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
6986 @end table
6987
6988 @node Initialization
6989 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
6990 @cindex initialization routines
6991 @cindex termination routines
6992 @cindex constructors, output of
6993 @cindex destructors, output of
6994
6995 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
6996 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
6997 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
6998 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
6999 @code{main} is called.
7000
7001 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
7002 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
7003 terminates.
7004
7005 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
7006 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
7007 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
7008 system, you need to specify how to do this.
7009
7010 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
7011 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
7012 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
7013
7014 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
7015 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
7016 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
7017 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
7018 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
7019
7020 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
7021 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
7022 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
7023 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
7024 pointer containing zero.
7025
7026 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
7027 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
7028 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
7029 list; destructors in forward order.
7030
7031 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
7032 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
7033 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
7034 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
7035 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
7036 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
7037 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
7038 Termination functions are handled similarly.
7039
7040 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
7041 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
7042 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
7043 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
7044 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
7045
7046 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
7047 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
7048 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
7049 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
7050 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
7051
7052 @example
7053 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
7054 @end example
7055
7056 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
7057 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
7058 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
7059 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
7060 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
7061
7062 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
7063 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
7064 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
7065 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
7066 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
7067 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
7068
7069 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
7070 macro properly.
7071
7072 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
7073 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
7074 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
7075 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
7076 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
7077 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
7078
7079 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
7080 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
7081 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
7082 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
7083 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
7084 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
7085 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
7086 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
7087 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
7088 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
7089 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
7090 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
7091 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
7092 the initialization process.
7093
7094 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
7095 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
7096 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
7097 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
7098 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
7099 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
7100 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
7101 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
7102 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
7103 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
7104 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
7105
7106 @ifinfo
7107 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
7108 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
7109 @end ifinfo
7110
7111 @node Macros for Initialization
7112 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
7113
7114 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
7115 and termination functions:
7116
7117 @table @code
7118 @findex INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7119 @item INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7120 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
7121 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
7122 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
7123 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
7124 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
7125 run the initialization functions.
7126
7127 @item HAS_INIT_SECTION
7128 @findex HAS_INIT_SECTION
7129 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
7130 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
7131 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
7132 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7133
7134 @item LD_INIT_SWITCH
7135 @findex LD_INIT_SWITCH
7136 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
7137 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
7138
7139 @item LD_FINI_SWITCH
7140 @findex LD_FINI_SWITCH
7141 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
7142 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
7143
7144 @item COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
7145 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
7146 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
7147 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
7148 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
7149 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
7150
7151 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
7152 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
7153 exception tables embedded in the code.
7154
7155 @item COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
7156 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
7157 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
7158 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
7159 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
7160 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
7161
7162 @item INVOKE__main
7163 @findex INVOKE__main
7164 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
7165 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
7166 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
7167 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
7168
7169 @item SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
7170 @findex SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
7171 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
7172 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
7173 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
7174 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
7175 @end table
7176
7177 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
7178 This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
7179 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
7180 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
7181 @end deftypefn
7182
7183 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
7184 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
7185 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
7186
7187 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
7188 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
7189 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
7190 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
7191
7192 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
7193 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
7194 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
7195 is not defined.
7196 @end deftypefn
7197
7198 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
7199 This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
7200 functions rather than initialization functions.
7201 @end deftypefn
7202
7203 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
7204 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
7205
7206 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
7207 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
7208 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
7209
7210 On certain kinds of systems, you can define these macros to make
7211 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
7212
7213 @table @code
7214 @findex OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
7215 @item OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
7216 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
7217 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
7218 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
7219
7220 @findex OBJECT_FORMAT_ROSE
7221 @item OBJECT_FORMAT_ROSE
7222 Define this macro if the system uses ROSE format object files, so that
7223 @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan object files directly
7224 for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
7225
7226 These macros are effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
7227 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
7228
7229 @findex REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
7230 @item REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
7231 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
7232 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
7233 @command{nm}.
7234
7235 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
7236 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
7237 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
7238 termination functions in shared libraries:
7239
7240 @findex LDD_SUFFIX
7241 @item LDD_SUFFIX
7242 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
7243 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{"ldd"} under SunOS 4.
7244
7245 @findex PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT
7246 @item PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
7247 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
7248 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
7249 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
7250 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
7251 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
7252 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
7253 @end table
7254
7255 @node Instruction Output
7256 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
7257
7258 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7259 This describes assembler instruction output.
7260
7261 @table @code
7262 @findex REGISTER_NAMES
7263 @item REGISTER_NAMES
7264 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
7265 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
7266 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
7267
7268 @findex ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
7269 @item ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
7270 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
7271 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
7272 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
7273 to registers using alternate names.
7274
7275 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE
7276 @item ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
7277 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
7278 requires different names for the machine instructions.
7279
7280 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
7281 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
7282 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
7283 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
7284 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
7285 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
7286 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
7287 so that it will not be output twice.
7288
7289 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
7290 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
7291 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
7292 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
7293 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
7294
7295 @findex recog_data.operand
7296 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
7297 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
7298
7299 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
7300 in the usual way.
7301
7302 @findex FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN
7303 @item FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
7304 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
7305 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
7306 they will be output differently.
7307
7308 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
7309 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
7310 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
7311 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
7312 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
7313 by changing the contents of the vector.
7314
7315 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
7316 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
7317 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
7318 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
7319 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
7320 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
7321
7322 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
7323
7324 @findex FINAL_PRESCAN_LABEL
7325 @item FINAL_PRESCAN_LABEL
7326 If defined, @code{FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN} will be called on each
7327 @code{CODE_LABEL}. In that case, @var{opvec} will be a null pointer and
7328 @var{noperands} will be zero.
7329
7330 @findex PRINT_OPERAND
7331 @item PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
7332 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
7333 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
7334 RTL expression.
7335
7336 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
7337 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
7338 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
7339 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
7340 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
7341 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
7342 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
7343
7344 @findex reg_names
7345 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
7346 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
7347 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
7348 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
7349
7350 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
7351 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
7352 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
7353 @var{code}.
7354
7355 @findex PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P
7356 @item PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
7357 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
7358 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
7359 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
7360 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
7361 in this way.
7362
7363 @findex PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS
7364 @item PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
7365 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
7366 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
7367 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
7368
7369 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
7370 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
7371 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
7372 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
7373 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler Format}.
7374
7375 @findex DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND
7376 @findex dbr_sequence_length
7377 @item DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND(@var{file})
7378 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
7379 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
7380 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
7381 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
7382 or whatever.
7383
7384 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
7385 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
7386 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
7387
7388 @findex final_sequence
7389 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
7390 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
7391 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
7392 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
7393 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
7394 being output.
7395
7396 @findex REGISTER_PREFIX
7397 @findex LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
7398 @findex USER_LABEL_PREFIX
7399 @findex IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
7400 @findex asm_fprintf
7401 @item REGISTER_PREFIX
7402 @itemx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
7403 @itemx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
7404 @itemx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
7405 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
7406 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
7407 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
7408 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
7409 files can define these macros differently.
7410
7411 @item ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS(@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
7412 @findex ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS
7413 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
7414 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
7415 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
7416 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
7417 statements. Note that upper case letters are reserved for future
7418 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
7419 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
7420 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
7421 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
7422 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
7423
7424 @findex ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
7425 @item ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
7426 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
7427 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
7428 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
7429 first variant.
7430
7431 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
7432 @smallexample
7433 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
7434 @end smallexample
7435 @noindent
7436 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
7437 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
7438 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
7439 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
7440 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
7441 alternatives within the braces than the value of
7442 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
7443
7444 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
7445 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
7446 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
7447
7448 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
7449 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
7450 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
7451 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
7452 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
7453 opcodes or operand order.
7454
7455 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH
7456 @item ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
7457 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
7458 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
7459 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
7460 profiling.
7461
7462 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP
7463 @item ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
7464 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
7465 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
7466 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
7467 profiling.
7468 @end table
7469
7470 @node Dispatch Tables
7471 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
7472
7473 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7474 This concerns dispatch tables.
7475
7476 @table @code
7477 @cindex dispatch table
7478 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT
7479 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
7480 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7481 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
7482 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
7483 definitions of these labels are output using
7484 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
7485 way here. For example,
7486
7487 @example
7488 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
7489 @var{value}, @var{rel})
7490 @end example
7491
7492 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
7493 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
7494 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
7495 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
7496 mode and flags can be read.
7497
7498 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT
7499 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
7500 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
7501 in a dispatch table are absolute.
7502
7503 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
7504 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
7505 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
7506 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
7507 For example,
7508
7509 @example
7510 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
7511 @end example
7512
7513 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL
7514 @item ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
7515 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
7516 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
7517 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
7518 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
7519 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
7520
7521 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
7522 for the table.
7523
7524 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
7525 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
7526
7527 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END
7528 @item ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
7529 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
7530 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
7531 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
7532 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
7533 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
7534 of the preceding label.
7535
7536 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
7537 the jump-table.
7538 @end table
7539
7540 @node Exception Region Output
7541 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
7542
7543 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7544
7545 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
7546 region.
7547
7548 @table @code
7549 @findex EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
7550 @item EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
7551 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
7552 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
7553 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
7554 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
7555
7556 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
7557 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
7558
7559 @findex EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
7560 @item EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
7561 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
7562 data section even though the target supports named sections. This
7563 might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
7564 collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
7565
7566 Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
7567 also defined.
7568
7569 @findex MASK_RETURN_ADDR
7570 @item MASK_RETURN_ADDR
7571 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
7572 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
7573
7574 @findex DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
7575 @item DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
7576 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
7577 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
7578 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
7579 @samp{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @samp{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
7580 or @samp{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of
7581 1.
7582
7583 If this macro is defined to 1, the DWARF 2 unwinder will be the default
7584 exception handling mechanism; otherwise, @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} will be used by
7585 default.
7586
7587 If this macro is defined to anything, the DWARF 2 unwinder will be used
7588 instead of inline unwinders and @code{__unwind_function} in the non-@code{setjmp} case.
7589
7590 @findex DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
7591 @item DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
7592 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
7593 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
7594 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
7595 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
7596 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
7597 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
7598
7599 @end table
7600
7601 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXCEPTION_SECTION ()
7602 If defined, a function that switches to the section in which the main
7603 exception table is to be placed (@pxref{Sections}). The default is a
7604 function that switches to a section named @code{.gcc_except_table} on
7605 machines that support named sections via
7606 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}, otherwise if @option{-fpic} or
7607 @option{-fPIC} is in effect, the @code{data_section}, otherwise the
7608 @code{readonly_data_section}.
7609 @end deftypefn
7610
7611 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EH_FRAME_SECTION ()
7612 If defined, a function that switches to the section in which the DWARF 2
7613 frame unwind information to be placed (@pxref{Sections}). The default
7614 is a function that outputs a standard GAS section directive, if
7615 @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, or else a data section
7616 directive followed by a synthetic label.
7617 @end deftypefn
7618
7619 @deftypevar {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
7620 Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
7621 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
7622 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
7623 true otherwise.
7624 @end deftypevar
7625
7626 @node Alignment Output
7627 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
7628
7629 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7630 This describes commands for alignment.
7631
7632 @table @code
7633 @findex JUMP_ALIGN
7634 @item JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
7635 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
7636 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
7637
7638 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
7639 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
7640 define the macro.
7641
7642 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
7643 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
7644 @code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
7645 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
7646
7647 @findex LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER
7648 @item LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
7649 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
7650 a @code{BARRIER}.
7651
7652 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
7653 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
7654 define the macro.
7655
7656 @findex LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
7657 @item LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
7658 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying
7659 @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
7660 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
7661
7662 @findex LOOP_ALIGN
7663 @item LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
7664 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
7665 a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
7666
7667 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
7668 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
7669 define the macro.
7670
7671 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
7672 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
7673 @code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
7674 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
7675
7676 @findex LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7677 @item LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7678 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN}.
7679 This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
7680
7681 @findex LABEL_ALIGN
7682 @item LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
7683 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
7684 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
7685 the maximum of the specified values is used.
7686
7687 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
7688 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
7689 @code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
7690 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
7691
7692 @findex LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7693 @item LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7694 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}.
7695 This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
7696
7697 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP
7698 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
7699 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7700 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
7701 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
7702 expression of type @code{int}.
7703
7704 @findex ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
7705 @item ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
7706 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
7707 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
7708 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
7709 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
7710 section.
7711
7712 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN
7713 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
7714 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7715 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
7716 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
7717
7718 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP
7719 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
7720 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
7721 for padding, if necessary.
7722
7723 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN
7724 @item ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
7725 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7726 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
7727 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
7728 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
7729 a C expression of type @code{int}.
7730 @end table
7731
7732 @need 3000
7733 @node Debugging Info
7734 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
7735
7736 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7737 This describes how to specify debugging information.
7738
7739 @menu
7740 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
7741 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
7742 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
7743 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
7744 * SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
7745 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
7746 @end menu
7747
7748 @node All Debuggers
7749 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
7750
7751 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7752 These macros affect all debugging formats.
7753
7754 @table @code
7755 @findex DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER
7756 @item DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
7757 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
7758 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
7759 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
7760 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
7761 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
7762 compiler and another for DBX@.
7763
7764 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
7765 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
7766 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
7767 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
7768 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
7769
7770 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
7771 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
7772 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
7773
7774 @findex DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET
7775 @item DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
7776 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
7777 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
7778 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
7779 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
7780 that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
7781 for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
7782 @option{-g} options is used.
7783
7784 @findex DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET
7785 @item DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
7786 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
7787 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
7788 @var{offset}.
7789
7790 @findex PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
7791 @item PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
7792 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
7793 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
7794 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
7795 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
7796 @code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
7797 @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
7798
7799 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
7800 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
7801 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined and
7802 @code{LINKER_DOES_NOT_WORK_WITH_DWARF2} is not defined, GCC uses the
7803 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
7804 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
7805
7806 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
7807 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
7808 @option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-1}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff},
7809 or @option{-gvms}.
7810 @end table
7811
7812 @node DBX Options
7813 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
7814
7815 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7816 These are specific options for DBX output.
7817
7818 @table @code
7819 @findex DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
7820 @item DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
7821 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
7822 in response to the @option{-g} option.
7823
7824 @findex XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
7825 @item XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
7826 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
7827 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
7828
7829 @findex DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
7830 @item DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
7831 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
7832 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
7833 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
7834 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
7835 if there is any occasion to.
7836
7837 @findex DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
7838 @item DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
7839 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
7840 in the text section.
7841
7842 @findex ASM_STABS_OP
7843 @item ASM_STABS_OP
7844 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
7845 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
7846 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
7847 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
7848
7849 @findex ASM_STABD_OP
7850 @item ASM_STABD_OP
7851 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
7852 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
7853 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
7854 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
7855 information format.
7856
7857 @findex ASM_STABN_OP
7858 @item ASM_STABN_OP
7859 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
7860 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
7861 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
7862 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
7863
7864 @findex DBX_NO_XREFS
7865 @item DBX_NO_XREFS
7866 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
7867 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
7868 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
7869 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
7870
7871 @findex DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
7872 @item DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
7873 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
7874 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
7875 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
7876 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
7877 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
7878 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
7879 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
7880
7881 @findex DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
7882 @item DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
7883 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
7884 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
7885 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
7886 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
7887 if backslash is correct for your system.
7888
7889 @findex DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
7890 @item DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
7891 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
7892 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
7893 variable.
7894
7895 @findex DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
7896 @item DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
7897 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
7898 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
7899
7900 @findex DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
7901 @item DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
7902 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
7903 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
7904 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
7905
7906 @findex DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
7907 @item DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
7908 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
7909 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
7910 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
7911
7912 @findex DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
7913 @item DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
7914 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
7915 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
7916 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
7917
7918 @findex DBX_MEMPARM_STABS_LETTER
7919 @item DBX_MEMPARM_STABS_LETTER
7920 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a stack
7921 parameter. The default is @code{'p'}.
7922
7923 @findex DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
7924 @item DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
7925 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
7926 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
7927 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
7928 code.
7929
7930 @findex DBX_LBRAC_FIRST
7931 @item DBX_LBRAC_FIRST
7932 Define this macro if the @code{N_LBRAC} symbol for a block should
7933 precede the debugging information for variables and functions defined in
7934 that block. Normally, in DBX format, the @code{N_LBRAC} symbol comes
7935 first.
7936
7937 @findex DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
7938 @item DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
7939 Define this macro if the value of a symbol describing the scope of a
7940 block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be relative to the start
7941 of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
7942
7943 @findex DBX_USE_BINCL
7944 @item DBX_USE_BINCL
7945 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
7946 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
7947 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
7948 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
7949 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
7950 number for a type number.
7951 @end table
7952
7953 @node DBX Hooks
7954 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
7955
7956 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7957 These are hooks for DBX format.
7958
7959 @table @code
7960 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC
7961 @item DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7962 Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
7963 information for the start of a scope level for variable names. The
7964 argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
7965 @code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
7966
7967 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC
7968 @item DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7969 Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
7970
7971 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN
7972 @item DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
7973 Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
7974 output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
7975
7976 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_ENUM
7977 @item DBX_OUTPUT_ENUM (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7978 Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
7979 output an enumeration type. The definition should be a C statement
7980 (sans semicolon) to output the appropriate information to @var{stream}
7981 for the type @var{type}.
7982
7983 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_END
7984 @item DBX_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_END (@var{stream}, @var{function})
7985 Define this macro if the target machine requires special output at the
7986 end of the debugging information for a function. The definition should
7987 be a C statement (sans semicolon) to output the appropriate information
7988 to @var{stream}. @var{function} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} node for
7989 the function.
7990
7991 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_STANDARD_TYPES
7992 @item DBX_OUTPUT_STANDARD_TYPES (@var{syms})
7993 Define this macro if you need to control the order of output of the
7994 standard data types at the beginning of compilation. The argument
7995 @var{syms} is a @code{tree} which is a chain of all the predefined
7996 global symbols, including names of data types.
7997
7998 Normally, DBX output starts with definitions of the types for integers
7999 and characters, followed by all the other predefined types of the
8000 particular language in no particular order.
8001
8002 On some machines, it is necessary to output different particular types
8003 first. To do this, define @code{DBX_OUTPUT_STANDARD_TYPES} to output
8004 those symbols in the necessary order. Any predefined types that you
8005 don't explicitly output will be output afterward in no particular order.
8006
8007 Be careful not to define this macro so that it works only for C@. There
8008 are no global variables to access most of the built-in types, because
8009 another language may have another set of types. The way to output a
8010 particular type is to look through @var{syms} to see if you can find it.
8011 Here is an example:
8012
8013 @smallexample
8014 @{
8015 tree decl;
8016 for (decl = syms; decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
8017 if (!strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (decl)),
8018 "long int"))
8019 dbxout_symbol (decl);
8020 @dots{}
8021 @}
8022 @end smallexample
8023
8024 @noindent
8025 This does nothing if the expected type does not exist.
8026
8027 See the function @code{init_decl_processing} in @file{c-decl.c} to find
8028 the names to use for all the built-in C types.
8029
8030 Here is another way of finding a particular type:
8031
8032 @c this is still overfull. --mew 10feb93
8033 @smallexample
8034 @{
8035 tree decl;
8036 for (decl = syms; decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
8037 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL
8038 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
8039 == INTEGER_CST)
8040 && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == 16
8041 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
8042 @group
8043 /* @r{This must be @code{unsigned short}.} */
8044 dbxout_symbol (decl);
8045 @dots{}
8046 @}
8047 @end group
8048 @end smallexample
8049
8050 @findex NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
8051 @item NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
8052 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
8053 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
8054 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
8055 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
8056
8057 @end table
8058
8059 @node File Names and DBX
8060 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
8061
8062 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8063 This describes file names in DBX format.
8064
8065 @table @code
8066 @findex DBX_WORKING_DIRECTORY
8067 @item DBX_WORKING_DIRECTORY
8068 Define this if DBX wants to have the current directory recorded in each
8069 object file.
8070
8071 Note that the working directory is always recorded if GDB extensions are
8072 enabled.
8073
8074 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME
8075 @item DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8076 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
8077 @var{stream} which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
8078 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
8079 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
8080
8081 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
8082 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
8083
8084 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
8085 @item DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8086 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
8087 @var{stream} which indicates that the current directory during
8088 compilation is named @var{name}.
8089
8090 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
8091 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
8092
8093 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
8094 @item DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8095 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
8096 compilation of the main source file @var{name}.
8097
8098 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
8099 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
8100
8101 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
8102 @item DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8103 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
8104 @var{stream} which indicates that file @var{name} is the current source
8105 file. This output is generated each time input shifts to a different
8106 source file as a result of @samp{#include}, the end of an included file,
8107 or a @samp{#line} command.
8108
8109 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
8110 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
8111 @end table
8112
8113 @need 2000
8114 @node SDB and DWARF
8115 @subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
8116
8117 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8118 Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
8119
8120 @table @code
8121 @findex SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
8122 @item SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
8123 Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
8124 for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
8125
8126 @findex DWARF_DEBUGGING_INFO
8127 @item DWARF_DEBUGGING_INFO
8128 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf format debugging output
8129 in response to the @option{-g} option.
8130
8131 @findex DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
8132 @item DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
8133 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
8134 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
8135
8136 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
8137 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
8138 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
8139 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
8140 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
8141
8142 @findex DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
8143 @item DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
8144 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
8145 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}
8146 (@pxref{Exception Region Output} is nonzero, GCC will output this
8147 information not matter how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
8148
8149 @findex LINKER_DOES_NOT_WORK_WITH_DWARF2
8150 @item LINKER_DOES_NOT_WORK_WITH_DWARF2
8151 Define this macro if the linker does not work with Dwarf version 2.
8152 Normally, if the user specifies only @option{-ggdb} GCC will use Dwarf
8153 version 2 if available; this macro disables this. See the description
8154 of the @code{PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE} macro for more details.
8155
8156 @findex DWARF2_GENERATE_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
8157 @item DWARF2_GENERATE_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
8158 By default, the Dwarf 2 debugging information generator will generate a
8159 label to mark the beginning of the text section. If it is better simply
8160 to use the name of the text section itself, rather than an explicit label,
8161 to indicate the beginning of the text section, define this macro to zero.
8162
8163 @findex DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
8164 @item DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
8165 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
8166 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
8167 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
8168
8169 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA
8170 @item ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
8171 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
8172 between the two given labels, using an integer of the given size.
8173
8174 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET
8175 @item ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
8176 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
8177 section-relative reference to the given label, using an integer of the
8178 given size.
8179
8180 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL
8181 @item ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
8182 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
8183 reference to the given label, using an integer of the given size.
8184
8185 @findex PUT_SDB_@dots{}
8186 @item PUT_SDB_@dots{}
8187 Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
8188 SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
8189 macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
8190 not define them yourself.
8191
8192 @findex SDB_DELIM
8193 @item SDB_DELIM
8194 Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
8195 SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
8196 delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
8197 a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
8198 required.
8199
8200 @findex SDB_GENERATE_FAKE
8201 @item SDB_GENERATE_FAKE
8202 Define this macro to override the usual method of constructing a dummy
8203 name for anonymous structure and union types. See @file{sdbout.c} for
8204 more information.
8205
8206 @findex SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
8207 @item SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
8208 Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
8209 union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
8210 allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
8211 it.
8212
8213 @findex SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
8214 @item SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
8215 Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
8216 enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
8217 assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
8218 @end table
8219
8220 @need 2000
8221 @node VMS Debug
8222 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
8223
8224 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8225 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
8226
8227 @table @code
8228 @findex VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
8229 @item VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
8230 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
8231 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
8232 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
8233 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
8234 behavior is controlled by @code{OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS} and
8235 @code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}.
8236 @end table
8237
8238 @node Floating Point
8239 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
8240 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
8241 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
8242
8243 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
8244 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
8245 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
8246 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
8247 doing the compilation.
8248
8249 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
8250 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
8251 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
8252 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
8253 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
8254 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
8255 target floating point formats are identical.
8256
8257 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
8258 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
8259 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
8260 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
8261
8262 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
8263 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
8264 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
8265 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
8266 quantity.
8267 @end defmac
8268
8269 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
8270 Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
8271 floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
8272 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
8273 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
8274 @end deftypefn
8275
8276 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
8277 Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
8278 @end deftypefn
8279
8280 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8281 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
8282 @end deftypefn
8283
8284 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8285 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
8286 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
8287 @end deftypefn
8288
8289 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
8290 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
8291 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
8292 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
8293 defined by the C language for both.
8294 @end deftypefn
8295
8296 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8297 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
8298 @end deftypefn
8299
8300 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8301 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
8302 @end deftypefn
8303
8304 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8305 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
8306 @end deftypefn
8307
8308 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
8309 Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
8310 @var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
8311 variable).
8312
8313 The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
8314 following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
8315 @code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
8316
8317 If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
8318 target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
8319 @code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
8320 @code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
8321 @end deftypefn
8322
8323 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8324 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
8325 @end deftypefn
8326
8327 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8328 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
8329 @end deftypefn
8330
8331 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
8332 Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}. The
8333 return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
8334 appropriate bit pattern to be output asa floating constant whose
8335 precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
8336 @end deftypefn
8337
8338 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8339 Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
8340 which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
8341 integral, it is truncated.
8342 @end deftypefn
8343
8344 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
8345 @findex REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT
8346 Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
8347 into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
8348 value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
8349 @end deftypefn
8350
8351 @node Mode Switching
8352 @section Mode Switching Instructions
8353 @cindex mode switching
8354 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
8355
8356 @table @code
8357 @findex OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING
8358 @item OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
8359 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
8360 switching in an optimizing compilation.
8361
8362 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
8363 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
8364 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
8365 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
8366 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
8367 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
8368 or @code{MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
8369
8370 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
8371 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
8372 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
8373 If you define this macro, you also have to define
8374 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
8375 @code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
8376 @code{NORMAL_MODE} is optional.
8377
8378 @findex NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
8379 @item NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
8380 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
8381 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
8382 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
8383 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
8384 The position of the initializer in the initializer - starting counting at
8385 zero - determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
8386 entity in question.
8387 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
8388 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
8389 switch is needed / supplied.
8390
8391 @findex MODE_NEEDED
8392 @item MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
8393 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
8394 @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
8395 return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
8396 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
8397 be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
8398
8399 @findex NORMAL_MODE
8400 @item NORMAL_MODE (@var{entity})
8401 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
8402 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
8403 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry and exit.
8404
8405 @findex MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE
8406 @item MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
8407 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
8408 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
8409 lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
8410 for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
8411 (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
8412 @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
8413
8414 @findex EMIT_MODE_SET
8415 @item EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
8416 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
8417 @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
8418 the insn(s) are to be inserted.
8419 @end table
8420
8421 @node Target Attributes
8422 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
8423 @cindex target attributes
8424 @cindex machine attributes
8425 @cindex attributes, target-specific
8426
8427 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
8428 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
8429 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
8430
8431 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
8432 If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
8433 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
8434 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
8435 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
8436 take.
8437 @end deftypevr
8438
8439 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
8440 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
8441 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
8442 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
8443 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
8444 supposed always to be compatible.
8445 @end deftypefn
8446
8447 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
8448 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
8449 newly defined @var{type}.
8450 @end deftypefn
8451
8452 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
8453 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
8454 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
8455 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
8456 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
8457 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
8458 merging.
8459 @end deftypefn
8460
8461 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
8462 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
8463 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
8464 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
8465 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
8466 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
8467 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
8468 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
8469
8470 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
8471 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport} for
8472 Windows targets, you should define the macro
8473 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. This links in a function
8474 called @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined
8475 as the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. This is done
8476 in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
8477 @end deftypefn
8478
8479 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
8480 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
8481 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
8482 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
8483 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
8484 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
8485 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
8486 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
8487 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
8488 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
8489 needed.
8490 @end deftypefn
8491
8492 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (tree @var{fndecl})
8493 @cindex inlining
8494 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
8495 into the current function, despite its having target-specific
8496 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
8497 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
8498 @end deftypefn
8499
8500 @node MIPS Coprocessors
8501 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
8502 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
8503
8504 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
8505 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. gcc supports
8506 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
8507 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
8508
8509 @smallexample
8510 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
8511 unsigned int d;
8512
8513 d = cp0count + 3;
8514 @end smallexample
8515
8516 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
8517 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
8518 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
8519
8520 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
8521 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
8522 later in the function.
8523
8524 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
8525 the FPU. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
8526 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
8527
8528 There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
8529 you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
8530
8531 @table @code
8532
8533 @item ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8534 @findex ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8535 A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
8536 alternate names of coprocessor registers. The format of each entry should be
8537 @smallexample
8538 @{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
8539 @end smallexample
8540 Default: empty.
8541
8542 @end table
8543
8544 @node Misc
8545 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
8546 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
8547
8548 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8549 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
8550
8551 @table @code
8552 @item PREDICATE_CODES
8553 @findex PREDICATE_CODES
8554 Define this if you have defined special-purpose predicates in the file
8555 @file{@var{machine}.c}. This macro is called within an initializer of an
8556 array of structures. The first field in the structure is the name of a
8557 predicate and the second field is an array of rtl codes. For each
8558 predicate, list all rtl codes that can be in expressions matched by the
8559 predicate. The list should have a trailing comma. Here is an example
8560 of two entries in the list for a typical RISC machine:
8561
8562 @smallexample
8563 #define PREDICATE_CODES \
8564 @{"gen_reg_rtx_operand", @{SUBREG, REG@}@}, \
8565 @{"reg_or_short_cint_operand", @{SUBREG, REG, CONST_INT@}@},
8566 @end smallexample
8567
8568 Defining this macro does not affect the generated code (however,
8569 incorrect definitions that omit an rtl code that may be matched by the
8570 predicate can cause the compiler to malfunction). Instead, it allows
8571 the table built by @file{genrecog} to be more compact and efficient,
8572 thus speeding up the compiler. The most important predicates to include
8573 in the list specified by this macro are those used in the most insn
8574 patterns.
8575
8576 For each predicate function named in @code{PREDICATE_CODES}, a
8577 declaration will be generated in @file{insn-codes.h}.
8578
8579 @item SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES
8580 @findex SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES
8581 Define this if you have special predicates that know special things
8582 about modes. Genrecog will warn about certain forms of
8583 @code{match_operand} without a mode; if the operand predicate is
8584 listed in @code{SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES}, the warning will be
8585 suppressed.
8586
8587 Here is an example from the IA-32 port (@code{ext_register_operand}
8588 specially checks for @code{HImode} or @code{SImode} in preparation
8589 for a byte extraction from @code{%ah} etc.).
8590
8591 @smallexample
8592 #define SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES \
8593 "ext_register_operand",
8594 @end smallexample
8595
8596 @findex CASE_VECTOR_MODE
8597 @item CASE_VECTOR_MODE
8598 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
8599 elements of a jump-table should have.
8600
8601 @findex CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE
8602 @item CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
8603 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
8604 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
8605 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
8606 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
8607 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
8608 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
8609 flags can be updated.
8610
8611 @findex CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
8612 @item CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
8613 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
8614 should contain relative addresses. If jump-tables never contain
8615 relative addresses, then you need not define this macro.
8616
8617 @findex CASE_DROPS_THROUGH
8618 @item CASE_DROPS_THROUGH
8619 Define this if control falls through a @code{case} insn when the index
8620 value is out of range. This means the specified default-label is
8621 actually ignored by the @code{case} insn proper.
8622
8623 @findex CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
8624 @item CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
8625 Define this to be the smallest number of different values for which it
8626 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
8627 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
8628 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
8629
8630 @findex CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
8631 @item CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
8632 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
8633 statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests. This is
8634 advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
8635 of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
8636 targets that would require a loop. By default, this macro returns
8637 @code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
8638 @code{false} otherwise.
8639
8640 @findex WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
8641 @item WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
8642 Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
8643 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
8644 Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
8645
8646 @findex LOAD_EXTEND_OP
8647 @item LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mode})
8648 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
8649 memory in @var{mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
8650 bits outside of @var{mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
8651 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
8652 of @var{mode} for which the
8653 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
8654 @code{NIL} for other modes.
8655
8656 This macro is not called with @var{mode} non-integral or with a width
8657 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
8658 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
8659 @code{NIL}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
8660 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
8661
8662 @findex SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
8663 @item SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
8664 Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
8665 extends.
8666
8667 @findex FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
8668 @item FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
8669 Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
8670 point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
8671 unsigned one.
8672
8673 @findex MOVE_MAX
8674 @item MOVE_MAX
8675 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
8676 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
8677
8678 @findex MAX_MOVE_MAX
8679 @item MAX_MOVE_MAX
8680 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
8681 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
8682 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
8683 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
8684 at run-time.
8685
8686 @findex SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
8687 @item SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
8688 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
8689 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
8690 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
8691 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
8692 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
8693 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
8694 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
8695 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
8696 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
8697 arguments to bit-field instructions.
8698
8699 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
8700 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
8701 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
8702
8703 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
8704 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
8705 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
8706 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
8707 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
8708
8709 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
8710
8711 @findex TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION
8712 @item TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
8713 A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
8714 ``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
8715 bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
8716 operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
8717
8718 On many machines, this expression can be 1.
8719
8720 @c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
8721 @c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
8722 When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
8723 modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
8724 If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
8725 such cases may improve things.
8726
8727 @findex STORE_FLAG_VALUE
8728 @item STORE_FLAG_VALUE
8729 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
8730 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
8731 (@samp{s@var{cond}}) when the condition is true. This description must
8732 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{s@var{cond}} patterns and all the
8733 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
8734
8735 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
8736 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
8737 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
8738 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
8739 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
8740 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
8741 @samp{s@var{cond}} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
8742 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
8743 the compiler.
8744
8745 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
8746 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
8747 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
8748 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
8749 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
8750 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
8751 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
8752 expression
8753
8754 @smallexample
8755 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
8756 @end smallexample
8757
8758 @noindent
8759 can be converted to
8760
8761 @smallexample
8762 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
8763 @end smallexample
8764
8765 @noindent
8766 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
8767 tested into the sign bit.
8768
8769 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
8770 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
8771 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
8772 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
8773 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
8774 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
8775
8776 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
8777 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
8778 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
8779 to be used:
8780
8781 @itemize @bullet
8782 @item
8783 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
8784 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
8785 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
8786 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
8787 combine the normalization with other operations.
8788
8789 @item
8790 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
8791 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
8792 other machines.
8793
8794 @item
8795 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
8796 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
8797 others.
8798
8799 @item
8800 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
8801 @end itemize
8802
8803 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
8804 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
8805 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
8806 those cases, e.g., one matching
8807
8808 @smallexample
8809 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
8810 @end smallexample
8811
8812 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
8813 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
8814 @samp{s@var{cond}} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
8815 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
8816 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
8817 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
8818 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptizer can be used to
8819 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
8820
8821 You need not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
8822 instructions.
8823
8824 @findex FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE
8825 @item FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
8826 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
8827 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
8828 Define this macro on machine that have comparison operations that return
8829 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
8830 this macro.
8831
8832 @findex Pmode
8833 @item Pmode
8834 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
8835 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
8836 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
8837 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
8838 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
8839
8840 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
8841 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
8842 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
8843 to @code{Pmode}.
8844
8845 @findex FUNCTION_MODE
8846 @item FUNCTION_MODE
8847 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
8848 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most machines this
8849 should be @code{QImode}.
8850
8851 @findex INTEGRATE_THRESHOLD
8852 @item INTEGRATE_THRESHOLD (@var{decl})
8853 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions above which the
8854 function @var{decl} should not be inlined. @var{decl} is a
8855 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} node.
8856
8857 The default definition of this macro is 64 plus 8 times the number of
8858 arguments that the function accepts. Some people think a larger
8859 threshold should be used on RISC machines.
8860
8861 @findex STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
8862 @item STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
8863 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
8864 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
8865 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
8866 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
8867 strict conformance to the C Standard.
8868
8869 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
8870 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
8871 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
8872
8873 @findex NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
8874 @item NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
8875 Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
8876 This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
8877 C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
8878 @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
8879
8880 @findex HANDLE_PRAGMA
8881 @item HANDLE_PRAGMA (@var{getc}, @var{ungetc}, @var{name})
8882 This macro is no longer supported. You must use
8883 @code{REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS} instead.
8884
8885 @findex REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS
8886 @findex #pragma
8887 @findex pragma
8888 @item REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
8889 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
8890 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
8891 @code{c_register_pragma} for each pragma. The macro may also do any
8892 setup required for the pragmas.
8893
8894 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
8895 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
8896 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
8897
8898 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
8899 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
8900
8901 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
8902 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
8903 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
8904
8905 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
8906
8907 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} establishes one pragma. The
8908 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
8909 pragma of the form
8910
8911 @smallexample
8912 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
8913 @end smallexample
8914
8915 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
8916 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
8917 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
8918 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
8919 @var{name} by calling @code{c_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
8920 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
8921 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}.
8922
8923 For an example use of this routine, see @file{c4x.h} and the callback
8924 routines defined in @file{c4x-c.c}.
8925
8926 Note that the use of @code{c_lex} is specific to the C and C++
8927 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
8928 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{c_lex} is going
8929 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
8930 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
8931 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
8932 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
8933 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
8934 code that uses @code{c_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
8935 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
8936 how to build this object file.
8937 @end deftypefun
8938
8939 @findex HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA
8940 @findex #pragma
8941 @findex pragma
8942 @item HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA
8943 Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want the System V style
8944 pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(<n>)} and @samp{#pragma weak <name>
8945 [=<value>]} to be supported by gcc.
8946
8947 The pack pragma specifies the maximum alignment (in bytes) of fields
8948 within a structure, in much the same way as the @samp{__aligned__} and
8949 @samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do. A pack value of zero resets
8950 the behavior to the default.
8951
8952 A subtlety for Microsoft Visual C/C++ style bit-field packing
8953 (e.g. -mms-bitfields) for targets that support it:
8954 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
8955 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
8956 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
8957 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
8958 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
8959 size is allocated).
8960
8961 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
8962 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
8963 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
8964 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
8965 may affect its placement.
8966
8967 The weak pragma only works if @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK} and
8968 @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} are defined. If enabled it allows the creation
8969 of specifically named weak labels, optionally with a value.
8970
8971 @findex HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_PUSH_POP
8972 @findex #pragma
8973 @findex pragma
8974 @item HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_PUSH_POP
8975 Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want to support the Win32
8976 style pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(push,@var{n})} and @samp{#pragma
8977 pack(pop)}. The @samp{pack(push,@var{n})} pragma specifies the maximum alignment
8978 (in bytes) of fields within a structure, in much the same way as the
8979 @samp{__aligned__} and @samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do. A
8980 pack value of zero resets the behavior to the default. Successive
8981 invocations of this pragma cause the previous values to be stacked, so
8982 that invocations of @samp{#pragma pack(pop)} will return to the previous
8983 value.
8984
8985 @findex DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
8986 @item DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
8987 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in identifier
8988 names. 0 means @samp{$} is not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed.
8989 1 is the default; there is no need to define this macro in that case.
8990 This macro controls the compiler proper; it does not affect the preprocessor.
8991
8992 @findex NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
8993 @item NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
8994 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8995 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
8996 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
8997 @samp{.} is used instead.
8998
8999 @findex NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
9000 @item NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
9001 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
9002 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
9003 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
9004 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
9005
9006 @findex DEFAULT_MAIN_RETURN
9007 @item DEFAULT_MAIN_RETURN
9008 Define this macro if the target system expects every program's @code{main}
9009 function to return a standard ``success'' value by default (if no other
9010 value is explicitly returned).
9011
9012 The definition should be a C statement (sans semicolon) to generate the
9013 appropriate rtl instructions. It is used only when compiling the end of
9014 @code{main}.
9015
9016 @item NEED_ATEXIT
9017 @findex NEED_ATEXIT
9018 Define this if the target system lacks the function @code{atexit}
9019 from the ISO C standard. If this macro is defined, a default definition
9020 will be provided to support C++. If @code{ON_EXIT} is not defined,
9021 a default @code{exit} function will also be provided.
9022
9023 @item ON_EXIT
9024 @findex ON_EXIT
9025 Define this macro if the target has another way to implement atexit
9026 functionality without replacing @code{exit}. For instance, SunOS 4 has
9027 a similar @code{on_exit} library function.
9028
9029 The definition should be a functional macro which can be used just like
9030 the @code{atexit} function.
9031
9032 @item EXIT_BODY
9033 @findex EXIT_BODY
9034 Define this if your @code{exit} function needs to do something
9035 besides calling an external function @code{_cleanup} before
9036 terminating with @code{_exit}. The @code{EXIT_BODY} macro is
9037 only needed if @code{NEED_ATEXIT} is defined and @code{ON_EXIT} is not
9038 defined.
9039
9040 @findex INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED
9041 @item INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
9042 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
9043 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
9044 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
9045 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
9046 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
9047 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
9048 you should define this macro.
9049
9050 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
9051
9052 @findex INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED
9053 @item INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
9054 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
9055 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
9056 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
9057 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
9058 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
9059 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
9060 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
9061 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
9062 slot of @var{insn}.
9063
9064 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
9065
9066 @findex MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
9067 @item MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (@var{insn})
9068 In rare cases, correct code generation requires extra machine
9069 dependent processing between the second jump optimization pass and
9070 delayed branch scheduling. On those machines, define this macro as a C
9071 statement to act on the code starting at @var{insn}.
9072
9073 @findex MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
9074 @item MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
9075 Define this macro if in some cases global symbols from one translation
9076 unit may not be bound to undefined symbols in another translation unit
9077 without user intervention. For instance, under Microsoft Windows
9078 symbols must be explicitly imported from shared libraries (DLLs).
9079
9080 @findex MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
9081 @item MD_ASM_CLOBBERS (@var{clobbers})
9082 A C statement that adds to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
9083 any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for all asms.
9084
9085 @findex MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE
9086 @item MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE
9087 Define this to the largest integer machine mode which can be used for
9088 operations other than load, store and copy operations.
9089
9090 You need only define this macro if the target holds values larger than
9091 @code{word_mode} in general purpose registers. Most targets should not define
9092 this macro.
9093
9094 @findex MATH_LIBRARY
9095 @item MATH_LIBRARY
9096 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
9097 in the system math library, or @samp{""} if the target does not have a
9098 separate math library.
9099
9100 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"-lm"} is wrong.
9101
9102 @findex LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
9103 @item LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
9104 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
9105 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
9106
9107 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
9108 is wrong.
9109
9110 @findex TARGET_HAS_F_SETLKW
9111 @item TARGET_HAS_F_SETLKW
9112 Define this macro if the target supports file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
9113 Note that this functionality is part of POSIX@.
9114 Defining @code{TARGET_HAS_F_SETLKW} will enable the test coverage code
9115 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
9116 if the program has forked.
9117
9118 @findex MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
9119 @item MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
9120
9121 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
9122 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
9123 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
9124 1 if it does use cc0.
9125
9126 @findex IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS
9127 @item IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS(@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
9128 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
9129 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
9130 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
9131 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
9132 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
9133 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
9134 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
9135
9136 @findex IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS
9137 @item IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS(@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
9138 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
9139 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
9140 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
9141 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
9142
9143 @findex IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN
9144 @item IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN(@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
9145 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
9146 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
9147 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
9148 about the currently processed blocks.
9149
9150 @findex IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL
9151 @item IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL(@var{ce_info})
9152 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
9153 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
9154 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
9155 to by @var{ce_info}.
9156
9157 @findex IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL
9158 @item IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL(@var{ce_info})
9159 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
9160 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
9161 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
9162 to by @var{ce_info}.
9163
9164 @findex IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS
9165 @item IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS(@var{ce_info})
9166 A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
9167 structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
9168
9169 @findex IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
9170 @item IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
9171 If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
9172 added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure. These should be initialized
9173 by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
9174
9175 @end table
9176
9177 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS ()
9178 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
9179 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
9180 necessary setup.
9181
9182 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
9183 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
9184 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
9185 instructions or prefetch instructions).
9186
9187 To create a built-in function, call the function @code{builtin_function}
9188 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
9189 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes} and @code{build_common_tree_nodes_2};
9190 only language front ends that use those two functions will call
9191 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
9192 @end deftypefn
9193
9194 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
9195
9196 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
9197 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
9198 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
9199 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
9200 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
9201 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
9202 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
9203 built-in function.
9204 @end deftypefn
9205
9206 @table @code
9207 @findex MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH
9208 @item MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH(@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
9209
9210 Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
9211 Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
9212 @var{branch2} is possible.
9213
9214 On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
9215 filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
9216 may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
9217
9218 @findex ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE
9219 @item ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE(@var{hard_reg})
9220
9221 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
9222 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
9223 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
9224 it has been saved into can be used. @code{ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}, if
9225 defined, is called at the start of register allocation once for each
9226 hard register that had its initial value copied by using
9227 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
9228 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
9229 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
9230 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
9231 @code{MEM}.
9232 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
9233 it might decide to use another register anyways.
9234 You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the definition of the
9235 macro, functions that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
9236 register in question will not be clobbered.
9237
9238 @findex TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
9239 @item TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
9240 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
9241 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
9242 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
9243
9244 @findex TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
9245 @item TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
9246 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
9247 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
9248 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
9249 executable files.
9250
9251 @findex COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
9252 @item COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
9253 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
9254 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
9255 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
9256 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
9257 lists.
9258
9259 @end table
9260
9261 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
9262 This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
9263 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
9264 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
9265 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
9266
9267 @smallexample
9268 static bool
9269 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
9270 @{
9271 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
9272 @}
9273 @end smallexample
9274 @end deftypefn